KATALOG Ultrazvukl
KATALOG Ultrazvukl
KATALOG Ultrazvukl
ULTRASONIC
SENSORS
Table of contents
Ultrasonic sensors
Contents Page
Type code _____________________________________________________________________________ 7
Selection table__________________________________________________________________________ 8
Operating principles and technology of ultrasonic sensors ___________________________________ 10
Selecting the correct sensor _____________________________________________________________ 12
Sensor principle ____________________________________________________________________ 12
Output functions ____________________________________________________________________ 14
Types/housing shapes _______________________________________________________________ 16
Electrical connections ________________________________________________________________ 19
Parameterisation____________________________________________________________________ 21
General information__________________________________________________________________ 23
Notes for installation and operation______________________________________________________ 24
Cylindrical form ________________________________________________________________________ 27
Series -12GM ______________________________________________________________________ 27
Series -18GK and -18GM _____________________________________________________________ 33
Series -30GM ______________________________________________________________________ 65
Block type ____________________________________________________________________________ 99
Series VariKont ® ___________________________________________________________________ 99
Series -FP________________________________________________________________________ 115
Series -F12 _______________________________________________________________________ 129
Series -F42 _______________________________________________________________________ 133
Series -F43 _______________________________________________________________________ 155
Series -F54 _______________________________________________________________________ 161
Series -F64 _______________________________________________________________________ 171
Series -D1________________________________________________________________________ 175
Series -LUC_______________________________________________________________________ 181
Sensors for double-sheet monitoring _____________________________________________________ 185
Evaluation units and power supplies _____________________________________________________ 201
UH3 ____________________________________________________________________________ 202
DA5... ___________________________________________________________________________ 208
WE77.. __________________________________________________________________________ 212
KFA6... __________________________________________________________________________ 214
Accessories _________________________________________________________________________ 217
Mating connectors _________________________________________________________________ 218
Mounting aids _____________________________________________________________________ 223
Programming units UB-PROG 2/UB PROG 3_____________________________________________ 233
Service software ULTRA 2001 ________________________________________________________ 234
Additional information _________________________________________________________________ 236
Standards ________________________________________________________________________ 236
Resistance of our housing materials to chemical substances_________________________________ 237
Protective enclosures _______________________________________________________________ 239
Glossary _________________________________________________________________________ 240
Alphabetical type index ________________________________________________________________ 244
1 3.09.20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
6 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Type code
Type code (without series LUC...)*
U Ultrasonic sensor
Design
B Basic series
BE Basic series through-beam sensors
C Advanced series
CC Advanced series, chemical-resistant sensors
J Initiator
DB Double sheet control (DBL: for label detection, DBK: splice detection)
Upper limit of sensing range
300 300 mm (example)
6000 6000 mm (example)
Type of housing
12 cylindrical housing, diameter 12 mm
18 cylindrical housing, diameter 18 mm
30 cylindrical housing, diameter 30 mm
U square housing VariKont (U1, U9)
FP square housing FP (FP1, FP...P1, FP...P5)
F42 square housing F42
F43 square housing F43
F54 square housing F54
F64 square housing F64
Threaded bushing (cylindrical type only)
with specification of length in mm (example: GM75, length = 75 mm)
GM Metal
GK Plastic
Electrical output
E0 1 x 3-wire, npn switching output, normally open
E2 1 x 3-wire, pnp switching output, normally open
E4 1 x 3-wire, npn switching output, normally open/normally closed
E5 1 x 3-wire, pnp switching output, normally open/normally closed
E6 2 x 3-wire, pnp switching output, normally open/normally closed
E7 2 x 3-wire, npn switching output, normally open/normally closed
E01 2 x 3-wire, npn switching output, normally open/normally closed
E23 2 x 3-wire, pnp switching output, normally open/normally closed
A2 2 x 3-wire, pnp switching output, antivalent
H1 for external evaluation, transmitter
H2 for external evaluation, receiver
H3 for external evaluation, transmitter/receiver
I Analogue output, 4 mA ... 20 mA
U Analogue output, 0/2 V ... 10 V
IU Analogue output 4 mA ... 20 mA + 0/ V2 ... 10 V or load-controlled
IUE2 Analogue output, load-controlled I/U and 1 switching output E2
IUE0 Analogue output, load-controlled I/U and 1 switching output E0
8B 8 bit data output, parallel
K Relay output (2K = 2 relay outputs)
R2 (RS) RS 232 interface (old designation)
Design (optional)
K Transducer separate from evaluation unit
for use in restricted spaces
Connections
- cable version
V1 plug connector, 4-pin, M12 x 1
V3 plug connector, 3-pin, M8 x 1
V7 plug connector, 7-pin, PG13,5
V15 plug connector, 5-pin, M12 x 1
V17 plug connector, 8-pin, M12 x 1
V95 plug connector, 5 pin, M18 x 1,5
1 3.09.20 05
U - - - -
Da te o f issu e
* The type codes for the LUC series can be found on page 181.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 7
Overview
Selection table
Connec-
Output tion
Übersicht
Klemmen
Push-pull
Stecker
Analog
Detection
Relais
Kabel
NPN
PNP
range
(max.)
ni
c Series -FP 6000 mm ●
tra ive
re
so
so r
l
c
U m i
e
Switch
output
Switch Ultrasonic
Series -12GM 400 mm
output receiver Series -18GM40 300 mm ● ● ●
Series -18GM75 1000 mm ● ● ● ●
Series -30GM 6000 mm ● ● ● ●
Ultrasonic
emitter
Series VariKont ® 3000 mm ● ● ● ● ●
Fixed reflector
UH3-KHD2-4E5 ● ●
UH3-KHD2-4I ● ●
UH3-T1-KT ● ● ●
DA5-IU... ● ● ●
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
1) on request
2) 10 ... 30 V DC without function of the current output
3) 10 ... 252 V DC / 20 ... 252 V AC
4) DC-Types: 10 ... 30 V DC,
DC/AC-Types: 20 ... 253 V DC
15 ... 253 V AC
5) only DC-T ypes
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
8 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Overview
Pulse prolongation
adjustable sound
Parameterisation
Synchronisation
selectable m ode
Timer-function/
Error indicator
angled head
Page
TEACH-IN/
lobe width
N.C./N.O./
interface
interface
Window
Parallel
(8 Bit)
Ser ial
input
10 ... 30 V DC ● 65
10 ... 30 V DC ● 99
10 ... 60 V DC ● 115
10 ... 30 V DC ● 161
18 ... 30 V DC 33
10 ... 30 V DC ● 1) ● ● 33
18 ... 30 V DC ● ● 65
20 ... 30 V DC ● 99
7,5 ... 30 V DC 171
10 ... 30 V DC ● ● ● 27
10 ... 30 V DC ! ● ● ● 33
18 ... 30 V DC !1) ● ● ● ● ! 33
10 ... 30 V DC ● ● ● ● ● 65
15 ... 30 V DC ● ● ● ● ● 99
15 ... 30 V DC ● ● ● ● ● ● 115
10 ... 30 V DC ● ● ! ! 129
D C/AC 4) ● ● ● 5) ● ! 133
15 ... 30 V DC 2) ● ● ● ● 155
10 ... 30 V DC ● ● ● 161
D C/AC 3) ● ● 175
10 ... 30 V DC ● ● 181
20 ... 30 V DC ● ● ● 185
24 V DC ● ● 185
20 ... 30 V DC ● ● 201
20 ... 30 V DC ● ● 201
20 ... 30 V DC ● 201
10 ... 30 V DC 201
90 ... 260 V AC
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
1) on request
2) 10 ... 30 V DC without function of the current output
3) 10 ... 252 V DC / 20 ... 252 V AC
4) DC -Types: 10 ... 30 V DC,
DC /AC-Types: 20 ... 253 V DC
15 ... 253 V AC
5) only DC-Types
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 9
Operating principles and technology of ultrasonic sensors
Operating principles and technology of The active range of the ultrasonic sensor is referred to as the
sensing range sd. This range is bounded by the lowest and
ultrasonic sensors highest sensing distances, whose values depend on the char-
Pepperl+Fuchs ultrasonic sensors operate with a piezoelectric acteristics of the transducer. The highest sensing distance is
transducer as the sound emitter and receiver. A patented de- given in the type code.
coupling layer in special material is used to decouple the ultra-
The ultrasonic sensor detects objects within its sensing range,
sonics to the air - an acoustically thin medium.
regardless of whether these objects approach the sensor axi-
This ultrasonic transducer is embedded, watertight, into the ally or move through the sound cone laterally.
sensor housing, in polyurethane foam.
.
Ultrasonic sensors are available with switching outputs and/or
analogue outputs, various output functions are available ac-
cording to type.
unusable
area sensing range sd
Transducer object
Decoupling
aperture angle
layer
sensor type; the pulse repetition frequency is between 14 Hz switching distance 1 switching distance 2
and 140 Hz. or or
lower limit upper limit
U
in a good approach.
In the formula obove, only the angle between the curve
and the centre-line (0°) has to be inserted (half opening
angle).
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
10 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Operating principles and technology of ultrasonic sensors
The figure shows the response ranges of typical objects, rath- heat is that the sensor has an additional temperature error of
er than the intensity distribution of the ultrasonic beam. Within 2 % in the heating phase from 0.5 h ... 1 h.
these ranges, the sensor detects the specified object A or B.
As a result of the lag of the internal temperature sensor in re-
Example: UC6000-FP... flecting the true current temperature, greater short-term fluctu-
ations may occur than are specified on the data sheet due to
a sudden change in the ambient temperature.
Max. object offset [m]
2 The relationships between the range of ultrasonic sensors and
the air temperature, as well as that between the range and the
1.5
B A relative humidity are shown in the following charts. The rela-
1 tionships shown here apply to sensors of the UC4000-30GM...
0.5 and UC500-30GM... series, but with regard to the specific
0
sensing range, apply in principle to all ultrasonic sensors.
1.5 12
2 0%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 10
5%
Distance [m]
8
20 %
60 %
6
Where A = flat plate, 100mm x 100 mm 100 %
B = round rod, diameter 25 mm 4
The details given in the type code relate to a flat standard
2
plate, 100 mm x 100 mm. This plate must be placed at right an-
gles to the axis of the beam. The packet of sound pulses is re- 0
flected away if the object is inclined to this axis and -40 -20 0 20 40 60 80 100
consequently the echo does not reach the sensor. Temperature [˚C]
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 11
Sensor principle
Selecting the correct sensor Ultrasonic sensors for double-sheet monitoring are suitable for
distinguishing between:
The range of ultrasonic sensor products is a large one due to
their wide range of deployment. Important selection criteria are - no sheet, a single sheet, a double sheet.
described in detail on the next five pages to assist you in se- - Base material
lecting the correct sensor type for your specific applications: - Base material with labels
The emitter and receiver are mounted facing each other. If the Reflex sensor mode
ultrasonic beam is broken by an object, then the switch output
The emitter and receiver are mounted in the same housing.
becomes active.
The ultrasonic beam is reflected back to the receiver by a fixed
reflector plate. Objects entering the sensing range are detect-
ed by:
Properties:
- High range, as the ultrasonic beam only travels the signal
distance once.
- Less susceptible to interference, thus suitable for difficult op-
erating conditions.
- Greater installation complexity, as two separate units must
be wired.
Double-sheet monitoring
Properties:
Double-sheet monitoring is a special application involving - Only one measuring head
through-beam sensors designed especially for this purpose. - High detection reliability of problematic objects (sound-ab-
This application originated in the printing industry and uses an sorbent objects or objects with angled surfaces)
ultrasonic beam to monitor the thickness of paper or foils. - Less susceptible to interference, thus suitable for difficult op-
erating conditions.
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
12 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Sensor principle
Reflection sensor The time of travel of the sound pulse is the means of measur-
ing the distance of the object. The sensors operate in direct
The emitter and receiver are mounted in the same housing (re- detection mode and have various analogue outputs, depend-
flection sensor). ing on the type:
The object acts as a sound reflector.
- Analogue voltage output: 0 V ...10 V
- Analogue current output: 4 mA ... 20 mA
- 8-bit parallel output
- Serial output, RS 232
Absolute: distance as a series of digits in [mm]
Relative: type ...RS: three-digit sequence (0 ... 254)
type ...R2: four-digit sequence (0 ... 4095)
Relative
Reflection sensor with twin-head 4 ... 20 mA / 0 ... 10 V
0 ... 4095 digit
Emitter and receiver are separate, the axes of the emitter and
Machine cycles
0 300 3000
Unusable A1 or A2 or Object
area Lower limit Upper limit distance [mm]
Properties:
- It is possible to detect very small objects.
- Three-dimensional sensing range
- Insensitive with regard to unwanted reflections from objects
outside the sensing range (background suppression)
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 13
Output functions
n.o.
UC3000... ∆ E > 2 % of 3000 mm = 60 mm Unusable area A1 A2 Object distance
UC6000... ∆ E > 2 % of 6000 mm = 120 mm
The area monitoring mode is supported by our UC... sensors.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
14 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Output functions
The outputs of the ultrasonic sensors can be realised in npn or The distance is issued in the form of an 8-bit data word in par-
in pnp technology. The sensors in this catalogue are mainly allel on three lines.
pnp types. In this case the load is connected to -L, at the
switching output of the sensor +L is connected to the load. Digital, serial
External evaluation
nal inputs. It has a relay output with adjustable pick-up and re-
lease delay.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 15
Series
Cylindrical form
Design: 12GM...
18GK...
18GM40... / 18GM40A...
18GM75...
30GM...
Properties:
- Sensor head and evaluation unit are separate. The unit can
therefore be installed in tight spaces.
- Material: Stainless steel.
Thread: M30 x 1.5 (amplifier electronics)
M18 x 1 or M30 x 1,5 (transducer head).
- Active area on the axial face
- Installation: In an existing threaded hole or using
Pepperl+Fuchs mounting aids (see Accessories section)
Design: LUC...
Properties:
- Material: Plastic, nickel-plated brass or stainless steel.
Thread: M12 x 1, M18 x 1 or M30 x 1.5
- Active area on the axial face
(18GM40 and 18GM75 also available with angled head)
- Installation: In an existing threaded hole or using
Pepperl+Fuchs mounting aids (see Accessories section) Properties:
- Material: PBT.
Thread: G1½A and 1½“ NPT in stainless steel or
polypropylene
Design: UC...-30GM... -T-... - Active area on the axial face
- Installation: In existing threaded flange
- Teflon-coated ultrasonic sensor for deployment in chemically
aggressive environments
Design: D1
Properties:
- Material: Plastic, stainless steel.
Thread: M30 x 1,5
- Active area on the axial face
- Best suitable for low-temperature applications
- Installation: In an existing threaded hole or using
Pepperl+Fuchs mounting aids (see Accessories section)
Properties:
- Material (housing): Plastic
- Material (flange): Stainless steel
- Single-hole mounting
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
16 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series
Properties:
- Robust housing, waterproof and nonbreakable
Material: dy cast zinc, nickel plated, PC, PBT
- Active area on the front face
- Multiple installation possibilities by means of slotted hole and
dove tail mount
Properties: - Best visible indicator LEDs at the front and at the rear side
- Material: PBT
- Active section is adjustable in 5 directions without affecting Connection via 90° turnable connector, M12 x 1
the mounting of the sensor.
- The electronic section can be replaced without changes to
the base of the sensor. The wiring and adjustment remain Design: F42
unaffected.
- Connection through terminal compartment
- Standardised mounting hole pattern as in mechanical roller-
lever limit switches (compliant with EN 60947)
Design: FP
Properties:
- Material: PBT
- Direct surface-installation without additional mounting
bracket
- Easy programming via built in keypad. No external program-
ming tool required
Properties: - LEDs for status indication and for user support through nu-
- Material: PBT merously programming routines
- Active area at right angle to mounting surface - Top-looker und side-looker designs availlable for ideal
- The electronic section can be replaced without changes to matching to the local conditions
the base of the sensor. The wiring and adjustment remain - DC-versions with semiconductor switching outputs or ana-
unaffected. logue outputs
- Connection through terminal compartment - AC/DC-versions with wide volage supply range and relay
output
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 17
Electrical connections
Properties:
- Material: PBT
- Direct surface mounting without additional mounting angles
- LEDs on the plug side
- No unusable area in the twin-head version
Design: F54
Properties:
- Material (evaluation unit, only UDB... devices): Makrolon
(UDC... devices do’nt have a separate evaluation unit)
- Material (sensor heads): Nickel-plated brass
- Non-contact distinction between single and double sheets
- Short response times to 1 ms
- Insensitive to dust and dirt
- Paper weights between 10 g and ca. 2000 g detectable
- Installation: In existing threaded holes or using the special
fork-mounting aid MH-UDB01 (see Accessories section)
Properties:
- Cubical housing, material: PBT Applications:
- Direct surface mounting without additional mounting angles The ultrasonic double-sheet monitor is deployed in all situa-
tions in which the automatic distinction between single and
double sheets is required in order to protect machines or avoid
Design: F64 waste production.
Properties:
- Through-beam ultrasonic barrier
- Cubical housing, material: PA
- Direct surface mounting without additional mounting angles
Da te o f ed ition 0 9/13/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
18 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Electrical connections
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 19
Parameterisation
Serial R2 Communication-enabled,
Standard symbol/Connection:
Rated operating voltage parameterisable sensor (Version E6, pnp)
10 V ... 30 V DC with RS 232 interface 1 + UB
5
Sync. Input
U 2
Old designation 4
Output 1, TD
Output 2, RD
(RS) 3 - UB
Parallel 8B Communication-enabled,
Standard symbol/Connection:
Rated operating voltage parameterisable sensor Transceiver (parallel interface)
20 V ... 30 V DC with 8-bit parallel output UB
+
A1 - A8 8-bit-output
A9 Error output
UB
-
E1 Test input
TD Transmit - Data
RD Receiver - Data
Note: The standard symbols shown here are examples. The types marked with * are not shown.
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
20 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Parameterisation
- UC500+U9+E6/E7+R2, UC500+U9+IUE2/IUE0+R2
- UC3000+U9+E6/E7+R2, UC3000+U9+IUE2/IUE0+R2 Switch S1 ... S8: adjustment of the switching range
- UB1000+FP1+E6 (200 mm ... 1000 mm)
- UC6000-FP-E6/E7-R2-P5, UC6000-FP-IUE2/IUE0-R2-P5 Switch S9: (0) normally closed/(1) normally open
Switch S10: (0) two independent switching points
Example 1: UC3000+U9+E6+R2
(1) measuring window
(sensor with 2 switching outputs
or RS 232 interface)
Programming plug
Switching mode
NO The following ultrasonic sensors are equipped with a program-
ON ming plug with an integrated temperature probe. The plug can
be connected in four different positions:
NC UC500 E6
RS 232 mode UC1000 E6R2
V1 A1 E2/E3
UCC1000 30GM E7R2 (K)
V15
UC2000 IU
Near Far UC4000 IUR2 T
UC6000 Coded plug
S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 A1/mm A2/mm
G5P
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 300 400 G5S
LUC4T IU V15
N5P
0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 450 550 N5S
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 21
General information
Switch output 2
When A1 > A2, both switch outputs are activated as (N.C.)
N.C. contacts.
A 1 (N.C.)
Switch output 1 Switch point 1 -> ∞: Switch output 1, (N.O.)
Detection of object presence
A2 (N.C.) Switch point 2 -> ∞: Switch output 2, (N.C.)
Switch output 2 Detection of object presence
2. Window mode
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect. Switching output: types ...E4/E5
A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1 1. Window mode, normally open function
A1 < A2: object range
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2 A1 A2
3. Hysteresis mode 2. Window mode, normally closed function
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect. A2 < A1:
A 1 (N.O.) A2 A1
Switch output 1
3. One switch point, normally open function
A2 (N.C.) A1 -> ∞:
Switch output 2
A2
Analogue output: types ...-IU and ...-IUR2 4. One switch point, normally closed function
A2 -> ∞:
Near distance Far distance
of evaluation of evaluation A1
20 mA/10 V 5. A1 -> ∞, A2 -> ∞: Detection of object presence
1) Object detected: Switch output closed
4 mA/ No object detected: Switch output open
0V
20 mA/
Switching output: types ...E6/E7
10 V
2) 1. Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Switch output 1
4 mA/0 V (N.O.) object range
20 mA/10 V
3) 4 mA/ Switch output 2
0V (N.O.)
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
22 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Notes for installation and operation
Example:
UC-F43-R2 programming adapter
A UC4000-30GM-IUR2-V1 sensor has been set up with the
The UC-F43-R2 programming adapter is designed to be in- following parameters:
serted between sensors of the -F43- series and the supply
lead. A 9-pin cable socket with 1 m of cable permit the sensor Upper limit: 3500 mm
to be connected to the RS 232 interface of a PC with ease. Lower limit: 800 mm
The usual wiring requirements become superfluous with the
In this application, the physical resolution of the sensor
use of the programming adapter.
amounts to
The PC service program Ultra 2001 can be used for the actual
programming of ultrasonic sensors of the -F43- series. (3500 mm - 800 mm) / 4096 = 0.66 mm.
UC-30GM-R2 programming adapter Ultrasonic sensors with 8-bit parallel output resolve the meas-
uring window in 256 steps. Their resolution can be calculated
The interface cable UC-30GM-R2 permits the parameterisati- as follows:
on of ultrasonic sensors series UC...-30GM-..R2-V15 using
the PC service program ULTRA 2001. This cable connects the (upper limit - lower limit) / 256
PC-internal RS 232-interface to the program/temperature sok-
if the measuring window has been set to a size greater than
ket of the sensor. During the parameterisation procedure, the
44 mm. For smaller measuring windows, the resolution is
program/temperature plug is unplugged.
0.172 mm. The resolution given in the data sheet is based on
the largest possible measuring window.
UC-FP/U9-R2 programming adapter
The interface cable UC-FP/U9-R2 permits the parameterisati- Accuracy (conformity error)
on of ultrasonic sensors series VariKont (U9) and FP, which
To determine the absolute accuracy of the measured value of
are equipped with a serial interface, (marked with R2 or RS in
an ultrasonic sensor, factors such as
model number). This cable connects the PC-internal RS 232-
interface to the according terminal screws in the sensor base. - temperature
- atmospheric pressure
- relative humidity
- turbulence
- hot spots in the air surrounding the sensor
- Sensor in hot operating mode status
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 23
Notes for installation and operation
In addition, tolerances of the electronic components and differ- 7. Notes for installation and operation
ences in the response characteristic of the ultrasonic sensor
due to varying signal strengths of the sound reflected by the Ultrasonic sensors can be installed and operated in any posi-
object also have an effect. tion. Avoid installation positions that may lead to impaired
Under consideration of all of these influences, an accuracy of functioning due to deposits of dust or dirt.
better than 2 % generally can be achieved, along with a repro- When cleaning ultrasonic sensors, take care not to damage
ducibility and linearity of better than 0.2 %. the sensor surface (decoupling layer) or the integral foam in
which the transducer is embedded.
Resistance to shock and vibration Water drops or the formation of crusts on the decoupling layer
will lead to an impairment of the ultrasonic sensor's function.
Pepperl+Fuchs ultrasonic sensors fulfill the DIN EN 60947-5- Light dust deposits are uncritical.
2 standards for low-voltage switching equipment, Part 5, Sec-
tion 2: Proximity Switches. A reference is made to the applica- Actuation direction
ble environmental testing procedures within the framework of
this standard. The objects to be detected can enter the sound beam from any
arbitrary direction. The sensor ranges and response curves in
Resistance to shock the data sheets represent the maximum object sensing rang-
es.
Our ultrasonic sensors were tested for their resistance to me-
chanical shocks in accordance with IEC 60068-2-27 under the
following conditions:
Electromagnetic compatibility
Deflection of the sound cone
The DIN EN 60947-5-2 "proximity switch standard" also refers
The sound cone can be deflected with smooth, even reflec-
to the applicable standards for the documentation of electro-
tors. Do not deflect the signal more than twice, however, as
magnetic compatibility. Pepperl+Fuchs ultrasonic sensors ful-
the signal damping that occurs with each deflection will result
fill the requirements of
in reduced range.
- Interference immunity in accordance with DIN EN 61000-4-2
(immunity to electrostatic discharge)
- Interference immunity in accordance with DIN EN 61000-4-3
(immunity to high-frequency interference)
- Interference immunity in accordance with DIN EN 61000-4-4
(immunity to fast transients)
- Emitted interference in accordance with EN 55011 and
DIN EN 50081-2.
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
24 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
An exact alignment of the reflector surfaces is required. Pep- Synchronisation
perl+Fuchs offers 45° reflectors for some sensor types to
achieve a deflection of 90°. Mutual interference of sensors with synchronisation inputs can
be prevented effectively by synchronising the sensors. A dis-
Mutual interference tinction is made between synchronised and multiplex mode.
X
Measuring plate/objects
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 25
Material properties such as transparency, colour, or surface The following objects are well-suited for detection:
finish (polished or matte) have no effect on detection reliability.
The roughness of the object's surface, together with the sen- - All smooth and solid objects that are aligned at a right angle
sor-specific transducer frequency, determines whether the to the sound cone.
echo is reflected or diffused. The following table contains a list- - All solid objects with degrees of surface roughness that
ing of the transducer frequencies used in Pepperl+Fuchs ultra- cause a diffuse reflection and which are to a large extent in-
sonic sensors and the associated degrees of surface dependent of their alignment.
roughness for the reflection or diffusion of the sensor signal. - The surfaces of liquids, insofar as these are not angled more
The following rule applies: than 3° from the axis of the sound cone.
If the sound wavelength is longer than the peak-to-valley
height of the surface roughness, the directional share of the The following materials are poorly suited:
reflection will predominate. If it is shorter than the peak-to-val-
- Materials that absorb ultrasonic signals such as felt, cotton
ley height, the diffuse share will predominate.
wool, coarse textiles, or plastic foam.
- Materials at temperatures greater than 100 °C.
Transducer Degree of object Degree of object It may be necessary to resort to through-beam operation for
frequency surface roughness surface roughness
such materials.
for a predomi- for a predomi-
nately directional nately diffuse
reflection reflection Sensors with adjustable sound cone width
65 kHz < 1 mm > 25 mm Some series offer a sound cone width adjustment in the close
range. This enables the operation of such sensors even at nar-
85 (90) kHz < 0.8 mm > 20 mm row places, where objects can extend sidewards into the
sound cone. Such circumstances would cause erratic swit-
120 (130) kHz < 0.5 mm > 13 mm ching ar erratic measurement under the use of sensors without
this feature. An adjustment of the sound cone can solve this
175 kHz < 0.4 mm > 10 mm
problem.
375 (400) kHz < 0.2 mm > 5 mm
The adjustment of the shape of the sound cone has no influ-
ence to the maximum sensing range.
The transition from directional to diffuse reflection is continu-
ous. Depths of roughness between the indicated values will re- Distance Y [m]
0.2
sult in reflections with diffuse and directional shares. Objects Flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
with great surface roughness will result in a reduction of the ul-
trasonic sensor's sensing range. 0.1
X
wide sonic beam
narrow sonic beam
If you have any questions pertaining to difficult applications, simply give us a call. Take advantage of our
help and experience. Our service team will be pleased to be of assistance.
Our contact addresses, you can find at the rear catalogue cover or in the chapter "Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH
worldwide" beginning at page 246
Da te o f ed ition 0 8/18/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
26 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -12GM
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Model number Detection range Page
UB400-12GM-E5-V1
Series
UB400-12GM-I-V1 400 mm 28
-F43
UB400-12GM-U-V1
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 9/13/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 27
Ultrasonic sensor UB400-12GM-..-V1
-12GM
Series
• TEACH-IN input
• Temperature compensation
-18GK/-18GM
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB400-12GM-E5-V1
UB400-12GM-U-V1
UB400-12GM-I-V1
Model number
Series
-F42
!
LUC
1 TEACH-IN input ! !
lower evaluation limit A1: -UB ... +1 V, upper evaluation limit A2: +4 V ... +UB
input impedance: > 4.7 kΩ, pulse duration: ≥ 1 s
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; foam polyurethane, cover PBT ! ! !
Mass 25 g ! ! !
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
28 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB400-12GM-..-V1
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
M12x1
Series
-30GM
4
41
48.4
17
(Torque)
70
max. 10 Nm
VariKont
Series
LED
6
M12x1
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
-F43
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB
2 (WH) 2 (WH) 2 (WH)
U Teach input U Teach input U Teach input
4 (BK) Analogue output 4 (BK) Analogue output 4 (BK) Switch output
3 (BU) - UB 3 (BU) - UB 3 (BU) - UB
Series
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function Programmed analogue output function
1. Window mode, normally open function Rising ramp
Distance Y [mm]
Double sheet
0
A1 -> ∞:
-100
A2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 29
Series -12GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
The ultrasonic sensor features a switch output with two teachable switching points. These are set by applying the supply volta-
ge -UB or +U B to the TEACH-IN input. The supply voltage must be applied to the TEACH-IN input for at least 1 s. LEDs indicate
whether the sensor has recognised the target during the TEACH-IN procedure. Switching point A1 is taught with -UB , A2 with
+UB .
Five different output functions can be set
Series
-30GM
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
30 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -12GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Output versions -I and -U:
-18GK/-18GM
Adjusting the evaluation limits
Series
The ultrasonic sensor features an analogue output with two teachable evaluation limits. These are set by applying the supply
voltage -UB or +U B to the TEACH-IN input. The supply voltage must be applied to the TEACH-IN input for at least 1 s. LEDs
indicate whether the sensor has recognised the target during the TEACH-IN procedure. The lower evaluation limit A1 is taught
with -U B, A2 with +UB .
Two different output functions can be set:
Series
-30GM
1. Analogue value increases with rising distance to object (rising ramp)
2. Analogue value falls with rising distance to object (falling ramp)
TEACH-IN rising ramp (A2 > A1)
VariKont
• Position object at lower evaluation limit
Series
• TEACH-IN lower limit A1 with - UB
• Position object at upper evaluation limit
• TEACH-IN upper limit A2 with + UB
Series
-FP
TEACH-IN falling ramp (A1 > A2):
• Position object at lower evaluation limit
• TEACH-IN lower limit A2 with + UB
Series
• Position object at upper evaluation limit
-F12
• TEACH-IN upper limit A1 with - UB
Default setting
A1: unusable area
Series
-F42
A2: nominal sensing range
Mode of operation: rising ramp
LED Displays
Series
-F43
TEACH-IN evaluation limit
Object detected off flashes
No object detected flashes off
Object uncertain (TEACH-IN invalid) on off
Series
Normal mode (evaluation range) off on
-F54
Fault on previous state
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 31
Series -12GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
32 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -18GK/-18GM
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
UB...-18GM40A... UB...-18GM40...
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
UBE500-18GK...
Series
-F12
UB...-18GM75...
Series
Model number Detection range Page
-F42
UBE500-18GK-SE0-V1 500 mm 34
UBE500-18GK-SE2-V1
UBE1000-18GM40-SE2-V1 1000 mm 36
Series
-F43
UB300-18GM40-E5-V1 300 mm 38
UB300-18GM40-I-V1
UB300-18GM40-U-V1
UB800-18GM40-E5-V1 800 mm
Series
UB800-18GM40-I-V1
-F54
UB800-18GM40-U-V1
UB300-18GM40A-E5-V1 300 mm 40
UB300-18GM40A-I-V1
UB300-18GM40A-U-V1
Series
-F64
UB800-18GM40A-E5-V1 800 mm
UB800-18GM40A-I-V1
UB800-18GM40A-U-V1
UB500-18GM75-E4-V15 500 mm 42
Series
UB500-18GM75-E5-V15
-D1
UB500-18GM75-I-V15
UB500-18GM75-U-V15
UB500-18GM75-E01-V15 500 mm 44
UB500-18GM75-E23-V15
Series
LUC
UB500-18GM75-E6-V15
UB500-18GM75-E7-V15
UB500-18GM75-F-V15 500 mm 46
Double sheet
monitoring
UB500-18GM75-BIT-V15
UB500-18GM75-PWM-V15
UB1000-18GM75-E4-V15 1000 mm 48
UB1000-18GM75-E5-V15
UB1000-18GM75-I-V15
Power supplies
Control units/
UB1000-18GM75-U-V15
UB1000-18GM75-E01-V15 1000 mm 50
UB1000-18GM75-E23-V15
UB1000-18GM75-E6-V15
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
UB1000-18GM75-E7-V15
UB1000-18GM75-F-V15 1000 mm 52
Accessories
UB1000-18GM75-BIT-V15
UB1000-18GM75-PWM-V15
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 33
Through-beam ultrasonic barrier UBE500-18GK-...-V1
-12GM
Series
• Plastic housing
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UBE500-18GK-SE0-V1
UBE500-18GK-SE2-V1
Model number
Series
-F42
25 mA emitter
Output type 1 switch output E0, npn NO !
1 switch output E2, pnp NO !
Rated operational current 200 mA ! !
Voltage drop ≤ 1,5 V ! !
Series
-F54
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
34 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UBE500-18GK-...-V1
-12GM
Series
43 ±0.1
-18GK/-18GM
ø50
Series
M3
60
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
M12x1
5
16
Series
16
-FP
M18x1
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol / Connection:
Receiver E2:
Series
-F43
1 (BN)
+UB
U 4 (BK)
3 (BU)
-UB
Receiver E0:
Series
-F54
1 (BN)
+UB
U 4 (BK)
3 (BU)
-UB
Series
Emitter:
-F64
1 (BN)
+UB
U
3 (BU)
-UB
Series
-D1
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
LUC
Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
monitoring
20 ≥10˚
α
10
A
Power supplies
1
Control units/
0.0 -0
0.1
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-10
0.2
Parallel displacement Angle displacement
0.3 A ≤ 8 mm α ≤ 5˚
-20
0.4
0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1..
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 35
Ultrasonic sensor UBE1000-18GM40-SE2-V1
-12GM
Series
• Short design, 40 mm
• Function indicators visible from all directions
-18GK/-18GM
• Switch output
Series
• TEACH-IN input
• Integrated alignment aid
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UBE1000-18G M40-SE2-V1
Model number
Series
-F42
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
36 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UBE1000-18GM40-SE2-V1
-12GM
Series
M18 x 1
-18GK/-18GM
Series
24.5
4
40.2
50.2
24
LED
Series
-30GM
M12 x 1
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
(version E2, pnp)
Series
-F43
Receiver:
1 (BN)
+UB
U 2 (WH)
Teaching input
4 (BK)
Switching output
3 (BU)
-UB
Series
-F54
Emitter:
1 (BN)
+UB
Series
U 2 (WH)
-F64
Test input
4 (BK)
n.c.
3 (BU)
-UB
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
20 80
15 70
10 60
5 50
Power supplies
0 40
Control units/
-5 30
-10 20
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-15 10
-20 0
0 200 400 600 800 1000 0 200 400 600 800 1000
d
X with Teach-In
Obstacle: flat plate 100 mm x 100 mm X without Teach-In
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 37
Ultrasonic sensor UB...-18GM40-..-V1
-12GM
Series
• Short design, 40 mm
• Function indicators visible from all directions
-18GK/-18GM
• TEACH-IN input
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Measuring window adjustable
UB...-18GM40-I-V1
UB...-18GM40-U-V1
Series
-30GM
• Switch output
UB...-18GM40-E5-V1
• 5 different output functions can be set
UB...-18GM40-E5-V1
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB300-18GM40-E5-V1
UB800-18GM40-E5-V1
UB300-18GM40-U-V1
UB800-18GM40-U-V1
UB300-18GM40-I-V1
UB800-18GM40-I-V1
Model number
Series
-F42
0 ... 50 mm ! ! !
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm ! ! ! ! ! !
Transducer frequency approx. 205 kHz ! ! !
approx. 390 kHz ! ! !
Response delay approx. 100 ms ! ! !
Series
-F54
approx. 30 ms ! ! !
LED yellow permanently yellow: object in the evaluation range, yellow, flashing: TEACH-IN function, object detected ! ! ! !
indication of the switching state, flashing: TEACH-IN function object detected ! !
LED red permanently red: Error, red, flashing: TEACH-IN function, object not detected ! ! ! ! ! !
Operating voltage 10 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS ! ! ! !
Series
-F64
≤1 %
LUC
Repeat accuracy ! !
± 0,5 % of full-scale value ! ! ! !
Rated operational current 200 mA , short-circuit/overload protected ! !
Voltage drop ≤3 V ! !
≤ 13 Hz
Double sheet
Switching frequency !
monitoring
≤ 4 Hz !
Range hysteresis 1 % of the set operating distance ! !
Load impedance > 1 kOhm ! !
0 ... 300 Ohm ! !
Temperature influence ± 1,5 % of full-scale value ! ! ! ! ! !
Input type 1 TEACH_IN input ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
lower evaluation limit A1: -UB ... +1 V, upper evaluation limit A2: +4 V ... +UB
input impedance: > 4.7 kΩ, pulse duration: ≥ 1 s
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! ! ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! ! ! ! !
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
38 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB...-18GM40-..-V1
-12GM
Series
M18 x 1
-18GK/-18GM
Series
24.5
4
40.2
50.2
24
LED
Series
-30GM
M12 x 1
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
-F43
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB
2 (WH) 2 (WH) 2 (WH)
U Teach input U Teach input U Teach input
4 (BK) Analogue output 4 (BK) Analogue output 4 (BK) Switch output
3 (BU) - UB 3 (BU) - UB 3 (BU) - UB
Series
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function Programmed analogue output function
1. Window mode, normally open function Rising ramp
Distance Y [mm] Distance Y [mm]
100 200
A1 < A2: object range A1 < A2:
object range
Double sheet
A1 A2
monitoring
150 A1 A2
50
2. Window mode, normally closed function Falling ramp
100
A2 < A1: A2 < A1:
1 50 A2 A1
2 2 A2 A1
0 1
0 3. One switch point, normally open function
A1 -> ∞:
-50
-50
A2
-100
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 39
Ultrasonic sensor UB...-18GM40A-..-V1
-12GM
Series
• Short design, 40 mm
• Function indicators visible from all directions
-18GK/-18GM
• TEACH-IN input
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Measuring window adjustable
UB...-18GM40A-I-V1
UB...-18GM40A-U-V1
Series
-30GM
• Switch output
UB...-18GM40A-E5-V1
• 5 different output functions can be set
UB...-18GM40A-E5-V1
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB300-18G M40A-E5-V1
UB800-18G M40A-E5-V1
UB300-18G M40A-U-V1
UB800-18G M40A-U-V1
UB300-18G M40A-I-V1
UB800-18G M40A-I-V1
Model number
Series
-F42
approx. 30 ms ! ! !
LED yellow permanently yellow: object in the evaluation range, yellow, flashing: TEACH-IN function, object detected ! ! ! !
indication of the switching state, flashing: TEACH-IN function object detected ! !
LED red permanently red: Error, red, flashing: TEACH-IN function, object not detected ! ! ! ! ! !
Operating voltage 10 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS ! ! ! !
Series
-F64
Repeat accuracy ≤1 % ! !
± 0,5 % of full-scale value ! ! ! !
Rated operational current 200 mA , short-circuit/overload protected ! !
Voltage drop ≤3 V ! !
Double sheet
monitoring
Switching frequency ≤ 13 Hz !
≤ 4 Hz !
Range hysteresis 1 % of the set operating distance ! !
Load impedance > 1 kOhm ! !
0 ... 300 Ohm ! !
Temperature influence ± 1,5 % of full-scale value ! ! ! ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
1 TEACH-IN input ! ! ! !
lower evaluation limit A1: -UB ... +1 V, upper evaluation limit A2: +4 V ... +UB
input impedance: > 4.7 kΩ, pulse duration: ≥ 1 s
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! ! ! ! !
Accessories
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
24.5 LED
39.2 10
67.7
VariKont
Series
Series
M12 x 1
M18 x 1
-FP
Series
-F12
24
4
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
-F43
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB
2 (WH) 2 (WH) 2 (WH)
U Teach input U Teach input U Teach input
4 (BK) Analogue output 4 (BK) Analogue output 4 (BK) Switch output
3 (BU) - UB 3 (BU) - UB 3 (BU) - UB
Series
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function Programmed analogue output function
1. Window mode, normally open function Rising ramp
Distance Y [mm] Distance Y [mm]
100 200
A1 < A2: object range A1 < A2:
object range
Double sheet
A1 A2
monitoring
150 A1 A2
50
2. Window mode, normally closed function Falling ramp
100
A2 < A1: A2 < A1:
1 50 A2 A1
2 2 A2 A1
0 1
0 3. One switch point, normally open function
A1 -> ∞:
-50
-50
A2
-100
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 41
Ultrasonic sensor UB500-18GM75-..-V15
-12GM
Series
• Synchronisation options
Series
• Deactivation option
• Temperature compensation
• Very small unusable area
• Switch output
Series
-30GM
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
Repeat accuracy ≤1 % ! !
± 0,1 % of full-scale value ! !
Rated operational current 200 mA , short-circuit/overload protected ! !
Voltage drop ≤3 V ! !
Switching frequency max. 8 Hz ! !
Series
LUC
! ! ! !
Connection connector V15 (M12 x 1), 5 pin ! ! ! !
Housing brass, nickel-plated ! ! ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; foam polyurethane, cover PBT ! ! ! !
Mass 60 g ! ! ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
42 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB500-18GM75-..-V15
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
M18 x 1
Series
-30GM
4
48
24
75
VariKont
Series
85
Series
-FP
LEDs
M12 x 1
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN) 1 (BN) 1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB + UB + UB
4 (BK) 2 (WH) 2 (WH)
Switch output Teaching input Teaching input
U 2 (WH) U 5 (GY) U 5 (GY)
Teaching input Synchronous Sync.
5 (GY) 4 (BK) 4 (BK)
Synchronous Switch output Analog output
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Standard symbol/Connections:
(version I)
1 (BN)
Series
+ UB
-F64
2 (WH)
Teaching input
U 5 (GY)
Sync.
4 (BK)
Analog output
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function Programmed analogue output function
Distance Y [mm] 1. Window mode, normally open function Rising ramp
Double sheet
400
object range
flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm A1 A2
300 A1 A2
2. Window mode, normally closed function Falling ramp
200
A2 < A1: A2 < A1:
100 A2 A1
A2 A1
Power supplies
A1 -> ∞:
-100
A2
-200
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 43
Ultrasonic sensor UB500-18GM75-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• 2 switch outputs
• Selectable sound lobe width
-18GK/-18GM
• TEACH-IN input
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Very small unusable area
• 3 different output functions can be set
UB500-18GM75-E7-V15
Series
-30GM
UB500-18GM75-E6-V15
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB500-18GM75-E01-V15
UB500-18GM75-E23-V15
UB500-18GM75-E7-V15
UB500-18GM75-E6-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Mass 60 g ! ! ! !
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
44 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB500-18GM75-...-V15
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
M18 x 1
Series
-30GM
4
48
24
75
VariKont
Series
85
Series
-FP
LEDs
M12 x 1
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN) 1 (BN) 1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB + UB + UB
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 4 (BK)
Switch output 1 Teaching input Switch output 1
U 2 (WH) U 4 (BK) U 2 (WH)
Switch output 2 Switch output 1 Switch output 2
5 (GY) 2 (WH) 5 (GY)
Teaching input Switch output 2 Teaching input
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Standard symbol/Connections:
(version E23, pnp)
1 (BN)
Series
+ UB
-F64
5 (GY) Teaching input
U 4 (BK)
Switch output 1
2 (WH)
Switch output 2
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function Programmed switching output function
1. Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Distance Y [mm]
Switch output 1 Switch output 1
Double sheet
monitoring
100
2. Switch point 2 Switch point 1
Power supplies
(N.C.)
-300
round bar, Ø 25 mm
-400
3.
0 200 400 600 900 1000
Switch point 1 -> ∞: Switch output 1, (N.C.)
Distance X [mm]
Detection of object presence
Accessories
output versions -E6 and -E7 output versions -E01 and -E23
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 45
Ultrasonic sensor UB500-18GM75-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• Synchronisation options
Series
• Deactivation option
• Temperature compensation
• Very small unusable area
Series
-30GM
• Frequency output
UB500-18GM75-F-V15
• PWM output
UB500-18GM75-PWM-V15
VariKont
UB500-18GM75-BIT-V15
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB500-18GM75-PWM-V15
UB500-18GM75-BIT-V15
UB500-18GM75-F-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
! ! !
Load impedance > 1000 Ohm < 100 nF ! ! !
Temperature influence ± 1,5 % of full-scale value ! ! !
Input type 1 Parameterisation input ! ! !
Input impedance: > 4.7 kΩ
Synchronisation 1 synchronous connection, bi-directional ! ! !
Series
0-level: -UB...+1 V
-D1
1-level: +4 V...+UB
input impedance: > 12 kΩ
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 95 Hz ! ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 95/n Hz, n = number of sensors ! ! !
Series
LUC
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
Protection degree IP65 ! ! !
Double sheet
monitoring
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
46 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB500-18GM75-...-V15
-12GM
Series
M18x1
-18GK/-18GM
Series
4
52
64
24
75
85
Series
-30GM
4
VariKont
LEDs
Series
M12x1
Series
-FP
LED green LED red
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connections:
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB
2 (WH)
Programming input
U 5 (GY)
Synchronous
4 (BK)
Output
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curve Anstiegs-/Abfallzeit des Ausgangssignals
Distance Y [m]
0.20
0.15
90%
0.10
Series
1
-D1
0.05
2 10%
0.00
-0.15
Series
+UB
LUC
-0.20 Q Lastimpedanz: 1 kΩ // 100 nF
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Y Distance X [m]
0V
X
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
Double sheet
T T T
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 47
Ultrasonic sensor UB1000-18GM75-..-V15
-12GM
Series
• Synchronisation options
Series
• Deactivation option
• Temperature compensation
• Very small unusable area
• Switch output
Series
-30GM
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
LED red permanently red: Error, red, flashing: TEACH-IN function, object not detected ! ! ! !
-F54
Repeat accuracy ≤1 %
-D1
! !
± 0,1 % of full-scale value ! !
Rated operational current 200 mA , short-circuit/overload protected ! !
Voltage drop ≤3 V ! !
Switching frequency max. 3 Hz ! !
Range hysteresis 1 % of the set operating distance
Series
! !
LUC
Multiplex operation ! ! ! !
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! ! !
Protection degree IP65 ! ! ! !
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
48 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB1000-18GM75-..-V15
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
M18 x 1
Series
-30GM
4
48
24
75
VariKont
Series
85
Series
-FP
LEDs
M12 x 1
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN) 1 (BN) 1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB + UB + UB
4 (BK) 2 (WH) 2 (WH)
Switch output Teaching input Teaching input
U 2 (WH) U 5 (GY) U 5 (GY)
Teaching input Synchronous Sync.
5 (GY) 4 (BK) 4 (BK)
Synchronous Switch output Analog output
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Standard symbol/Connections:
(version I)
1 (BN)
Series
+ UB
-F64
2 (WH)
Teaching input
U 5 (GY)
Sync.
4 (BK)
Analog output
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function Programmed analogue output function
1. Window mode, normally open function Rising ramp
Distance Y [mm]
Double sheet
1000
object range
flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm A1 A2 A1 A2
750
2. Window mode, normally closed function Falling ramp
500 A2 < A1: A2 < A1:
250 A2 A1
A2 A1
Power supplies
A1 -> ∞:
-250
-500 A2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 49
Ultrasonic sensor UB1000-18GM75-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• 2 switch outputs
• Selectable sound lobe width
-18GK/-18GM
• TEACH-IN input
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Very small unusable area
• 3 different output functions can be set
UB1000-18GM75-E6-V15
Series
-30GM
UB1000-18GM75-E7-V15
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
Material
Housing brass, nickel-plated ! ! ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; foam polyurethane, cover PBT ! ! ! !
Mass 60 g ! ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
50 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB1000-18GM75-...-V15
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
M18 x 1
Series
-30GM
4
48
24
75
VariKont
Series
85
Series
-FP
LEDs
M12 x 1
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN) 1 (BN) 1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB + UB + UB
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 4 (BK)
Switch output 1 Teaching input Switch output 1
U 2 (WH) U 4 (BK) U 2 (WH)
Switch output 2 Switch output 1 Switch output 2
5 (GY) 2 (WH) 5 (GY)
Teaching input Switch output 2 Teaching input
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Standard symbol/Connections:
(version E23, pnp)
1 (BN)
Series
+ UB
-F64
5 (GY) Teaching input
U 4 (BK)
Switch output 1
2 (WH)
Switch output 2
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function Programmed switching output function
1. Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Distance Y [mm] Switch output 1 Switch output 1
Double sheet
monitoring
250
2. Switch point 2 Switch point 1
Power supplies
-750 (N.C.)
round bar, Ø 25 mm
-1000
3.
0 500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000
Distance X [mm] Switch point 1 -> ∞: Switch output 1, (N.C.)
Detection of object presence
Accessories
output versions -E6 and -E7 output versions -E01 and -E23
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 51
Ultrasonic sensor UB1000-18GM75-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• Synchronisation options
Series
• Deactivation option
• Temperature compensation
• Frequency output
UB1000-18GM75-F-V15
Series
-30GM
• PWM output
UB1000-18GM75-PWM-V15
• Serial digital output
UB1000-18GM75-BIT-V15
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB1000-18GM75-PWM-V15
UB1000-18GM75-BIT-V15
UB1000-18GM75-F-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
! ! !
-D1
0 level -UB...+1 V
1 level: +4 V...+UB
input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 30 Hz ! ! !
Series
Multiplex operation
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
! ! !
Double sheet
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
52 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB1000-18GM75-...-V15
-12GM
Series
M18x1
-18GK/-18GM
Series
4
52
64
24
75
85
Series
-30GM
4
VariKont
LEDs
Series
M12x1
Series
-FP
LED green LED red
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connections:
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB
2 (WH)
Programming input
U 5 (GY)
Synchronous
4 (BK)
Output
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curves Rise-/fall time of output signal
Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
90%
Series
10
-D1
10%
0.0 -0
2 1
0.2 4.5µs 2.5µs t
0.4
-10
0.6
Series
+UB
LUC
0.8
Q Load impedance: 1 kΩ // 100 nF
-20
1.0
1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 2.2 2.4 2.6
Distance [m] 0V
T T T
max. max. max.
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 53
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Function
A through-beam ultrasonic barrier always consists of a single emitter and a single receiver. The function of a through-beam
ultrasonic barrier is based in the interruption of the sound transmission to the receiver by the object to be detected.
The emitter sends an ultrasonic signal that is evaluated by the receiver. If the signal is interrupted or muted by the object to be
Series
-30GM
Installation tolerances
Series
The installation tolerances of the central axes of the emitter and receiver may not exceed the values specified in the illustration.
Detection of thin foils
Series
For the detection of thin foils (< 0.1 mm), install the through-beam ultrasonic barrier at an angle of > 10° from perpendicular to
-FP
the foil.
Caution
Mount or replace emitter and receiver only in pairs. Both devices are optimally matched to each other by the manufacturer.
Series
-F12
UBE1000-18GM40-SE2-V1
Function
Series
-F42
A through-beam ultrasonic barrier always consists of a single emitter and a single receiver. The function of a through-beam
ultrasonic barrier is based in the interruption of the sound transmission to the receiver by the object to be detected.
The emitter sends an ultrasonic signal that is evaluated by the receiver. If the signal is interrupted or muted by the object to be
detected, the receiver switches.
No electrical connections are required between the emitter and receiver.
Series
-F43
The function of through-beam ultrasonic barriers is not dependent on the position of their installation. We recommend, however,
to install the emitter below in the case of vertical installations to prevent the accumulation of dust particles.
Startup and parameterising
Series
For easy alignment of emitter and receiver towards each other, the receiver is equipped with an alignment aid. To activate the
-F54
alignment aid, the TEACH-Input of the receiver (pin 2) has to be connected to ground (-U B ). The flashing frequency of the yel-
low LED indicates the strength of the received ultrasonic signal. The better the alignment, the stronger the signal.
LED yellow, flashing frequency Description
Series
Simultaneously the ultrasonic barrier evaluates the signal strength of the unobstructed signal path and generates the optimal
Series
-D1
switching threshold. When disconnecting the TEACH-input from -UB , this threshold is stored non-volatile in the receivers me-
mory. In case of clear ultrasonic path (no object), all LEDs are off.
TEACH-In of very small objects/obstacles
Series
Like shown in the curve "obstacle size", the ultrasonic barrier offers the possibility to detect very small objects at a distance of
LUC
- disconnect TEACH-input
In case of successful TEACH-IN (object is detected reliable), the yellow LED is on and the taught detection threshold is stored
non-volatile to the receivers memory.
In case of unsuccessful TEACH-IN (object too small or too porous for ultrasonic sound),the red LED flashes 5 times and the
ultrasonic barrier continues normal operation with unmodified detection threshold value.
Power supplies
Control units/
Test function
For test purpose, the ultrasonic emitter is equipped with a test input. In normal operation mode (test input not connected or
connected to -UB ), the green LED of the emitter is on. If the test input is connected to +UB , the ultrasonic emitter gets deacti-
Date of edi ti on 0 8/17/20 05
vated and its LED changes into red. Simultaneously the receiver switches and its yellow LED goes on.
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
54 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UB...-18GM40(A)-... , output type -E5 (1 switch output)
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Adjusting the switching points
The ultrasonic sensor features a switch output with two teachable switching points. These are set by applying the supply volta-
ge -U B or +UB to the TEACH-IN input. The supply voltage must be applied to the TEACH-IN input for at least 1 s. LEDs indicate
whether the sensor has recognised the target during the TEACH-IN procedure. Switching point A1 is taught with -U B , A2 with
+U B .
Series
-30GM
Five different output functions can be set
1. Window mode, normally-open function
2. Window mode, normally-closed function
3. one switching point, normally-open function
VariKont
Series
4. one switching point, normally-closed function
5. Detection of object presence
TEACH-IN window mode, normally-open function
- Set target to near switching point
Series
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
-FP
- Set target to far switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
TEACH-IN window mode, normally-closed function
Series
-F12
- Set target to near switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
- Set target to far switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
Series
-F42
TEACH-IN switching point, normally-open function
- Set target to near switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
- Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
Series
-F43
TEACH-IN switching point, normally-closed function
- Set target to near switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
- Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
Series
-F54
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
TEACH-IN detection of objects presence
- Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
Series
-F64
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
Series
-D1
LED Displays
The ultrasonic sensor features an analogue output with two teachable evaluation limits. These are set by applying the supply
voltage -UB or +U B to the TEACH-IN input. The supply voltage must be applied to the TEACH-IN input for at least 1 s. LEDs
indicate whether the sensor has recognised the target during the TEACH-IN procedure. The lower evaluation limit A1 is taught
with -U B, A2 with +UB .
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 55
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Installation conditions
If the sensor is installed at places, where the environment temperature can fall below 0 °C, for the sensors fixation, one of the
mounting flanges BF18, BF18-F or BF 5-30 must be used.
Series
-F43
In case of direct mounting of the sensor in a through hole using the steel nuts, it has to be fixed at the middle of the housing
thread. If a fixation at the front end of the threaded housing is required, plastic nuts with centering ring (accessories) must be
used.
Synchronisation
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor wi ll
operate using an internally generated clock rate. The synchronisation of multiple sensors can be realised as follows:
Series
-F64
External synchronisation
The sensor can be synchronised by the external application of a square wave voltage. A synchronisation pulse at the synchro-
nisation input starts a measuring cycle. The pulse must have a duration greater than 100 µs. The measuring cycle starts with
the falling edge of a synchronisation pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal operation
of the sensor. A high level at the synchronisation input disables the sensor.
Series
-D1
power is applied, these sensors will operate in multiplex mode. The response delay increases according to the number of sen-
sors to be synchronised. Synchronisation cannot be performed during TEACH-IN and vice versa. The sensors must be opera-
ted in an unsynchronised manner to teach the switching point.
Double sheet
monitoring
Note:
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input has to be connected to ground (0V) or the sensor has to
be operated via a V1 cable connector (4-pin).
Adjusting the switching points
The ultrasonic sensor features a switch output with two teachable switching points. These are set by applying the supply volta-
Power supplies
Control units/
ge -UB or +U B to the TEACH-IN input. The supply voltage must be applied to the TEACH-IN input for at least 1 s. LEDs indicate
whether the sensor has recognised the target during the TEACH-IN procedure. Switching point A1 is taught with -UB , A2 with
+UB .
Five different output functions can be set
Date of edi ti on 0 8/17/20 05
-12GM
Series
- Set target to near switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
-18GK/-18GM
- Set target to far switching point
Series
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
TEACH-IN window mode, normally-closed function
- Set target to near switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
Series
-30GM
- Set target to far switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
TEACH-IN switching point, normally-open function
- Set target to near switching point
VariKont
Series
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
- Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
TEACH-IN switching point, normally-closed function
Series
-FP
- Set target to near switching point
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
- Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
Series
-F12
TEACH-IN detection of object presence
- Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
- TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -U B
- TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +U B
Series
-F42
Default setting of switching points
A1 = unusable area
A2 = nominal sensing range
LED Displays
Series
-F43
Displays in dependence on operating mode Red LED Yellow LED
TEACH-IN switching point:
Object detected off flashes
Series
No object detected flashes off
-F54
Object uncertain (TEACH-IN invalid) on off
Normal operation off switching
state
Fault on previous
Series
state
-F64
Adjusting the sound cone characteristics:
The ultrasonic sensor enables two different shapes of the sound cone, a wide angle sound cone and a small angle sound cone.
Series
-D1
1. Small angle sound cone
- switch off the power supply
- connect the Teach-input wire to -UB
- switch on the power supply
Series
LUC
- the red LED flashes once with a pause before the next. pause
- yellow LED: permanently on: indicates the presence of an object or disturbing object within
the sensing range
- disconnect the Teach-input wire from -UB and the changing is saved
Double sheet
monitoring
• yellow LED: permanently on: indicates an object or disturbing object within the sensing
range
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
• disconnect the Teach-input wire from +UB and the changing is saved
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 57
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
the supply voltage -UB or +U B to the TEACH-IN input. The supply voltage must be applied to the TEACH-IN input for at least
Series
1 s. LEDs indicate whether the sensor has recognised the target during the TEACH-IN procedure. Switching point A1 is taught
with -U B, A2 with +UB .
TEACH-IN switching point for switch output 1
• Set target of desired switching point for switch output 1
Series
-30GM
Comments
Only one switch output can be configured for detection of presence of objects. If the sensor detects an objects within the ma-
ximum detection range, the switch output switches.
Series
-F12
The ultrasonic sensor enables two different shapes of the sound cone, a wide angle sound cone and a small angle sound cone.
- yellow LED: permanently on: indicates the presence of an object or disturbing object within
the sensing range
- disconnect the Teach-input wire from -U B and the changing is saved
• the red LED double-flashes with a long pause before the next. pause
• yellow LED: permanently on: indicates an object or disturbing object within the sensing
Accessories
range
• disconnect the Teach-input wire from +U B and the changing is saved
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
58 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UB...-18GM75-..., output types -E6 and -E7 (2 switch outputs)
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Adjusting the switching points
The ultrasonic sensor features two switch outputs with one teachable switching point. The switching points are set by applying
the supply voltage -U B or +UB to the TEACH-IN input.
The supply voltage must be applied to the TEACH-IN input for at least 1 s. LEDs indicate whether the sensor has recognised
Series
-30GM
the target during the TEACH-IN procedure. Switching point A1 is taught with -UB , A2 with +U B .
Three different output functions can be set:
1. normally-open function
2. normally-closed function
VariKont
3. Detection of object presence
Series
TEACH-IN normally-open function
Switching point for switch output 1 < switching point for switch output 2
• Set target of desired switching point for switch output 1
Series
• TEACH-IN switching point for switch output 1 with -UB
-FP
• Set target of desired switching point for switch output 2
• TEACH-IN switching point for switch output 2 with +UB
Comments: The order doesn't make any difference. If you want, you can set only one switching point.
Series
-F12
TEACH-IN normally-closed function
Switching point for switch output 2 < switching point for switch output 1
• Set target of desired switching point for switch output 1
• TEACH-IN switching point for switch output 1 with -UB
Series
-F42
• Set target of desired switching point for switch output 2
• TEACH-IN switching point for switch output 2 with +UB
Comments: The order doesn't make any difference. If you want, you can set only one switching point. If both switching points
Series
are equal, the sensor works in close function.
-F43
TEACH-IN detection of object presence
• Cover the sensor with the palm, or remove all objects from the detection range of the sensor
• TEACH-IN switching point for switch output 1 with -UB
Series
-F54
• TEACH-IN switching point for switch output 2 with +UB
Comments
Only one switch output can be configured for detection of presence of objects. If the sensor detects an object within the maxi-
mum detection range, the switch output switches.
Series
-F64
Default setting of switching points
Switch output 1: unusable area
Switch output 2: nominal sensing range
LED Displays
Series
-D1
Displays in dependence on operating Red LED 1 yellow LED 2 yellow
mode LED
TEACH-IN switching point 1
Object detected off flashes off
Series
LUC
No object detected flas- off off
Object uncertain (TEACH-IN invalid) hes off off
on
TEACH-IN switching point 2:
Double sheet
monitoring
The ultrasonic sensor enables two different shapes of the sound cone, a wide angle sound cone and a small angle sound cone.
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 59
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
- the red LED flashes once with a pause before the next. pause
- yellow LED: permanently on: indicates the presence of an object or disturbing object within
-18GK/-18GM
• yellow LED: permanently on: indicates an object or disturbing object within the sensing
Series
range
• disconnect the Teach-input wire from +U B and the changing is saved
Series
-FP
Synchronisation
Series
-F12
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor wi ll
operate using an internally generated clock rate. The synchronisation of multiple sensors can be realised as follows:
External synchronisation
The sensor can be synchronised by the external application of a square wave voltage. A synchronisation pulse at the synchro-
Series
nisation input starts a measuring cycle. The pulse must have a duration greater than 100 µs. The measuring cycle starts with
-F42
the falling edge of a synchronisation pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal operation
of the sensor. A high level at the synchronisation input disables the sensor. Two operating modes are available:
1. Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors are synchronised.
2. The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to individual sensors. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
Series
-F43
Internal synchronisation
The synchronisation connections of up to 5 sensors capable of internal synchronisation are connected to one another. When
power is applied, these sensors will operate in multiplex mode.
The response delay increases according to the number of sensors to be synchronised. Synchronisation cannot be performed
Series
during TEACH-IN and vice versa. The sensors must be operated in an unsynchronised manner to teach the evaluation limits.
-F54
Note:
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input has to be connected to ground (0V) or the sensor has to
be operated via a V1 cable connector (4-pin).
Series
-F64
Default setting
A1: unusable area
A2: nominal sensing range
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
60 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Displays in dependence on operating mode Red LED Yellow LED
-18GK/-18GM
TEACH-IN evaluation limit
Series
Object detected off flashes
No object detected flashes off
Object uncertain (TEACH-IN invalid) on off
Normal mode (evaluation range) off on
Fault on previous state
Series
-30GM
Adjusting the sound cone characteristics:
The ultrasonic sensor enables two different shapes of the sound cone, a wide angle sound cone and a small angle sound cone.
VariKont
Series
1. Small angle sound cone
- switch off the power supply
- connect the Teach-input wire to -UB
- switch on the power supply
- the red LED flashes once with a pause before the next.
Series
-FP
pause
- yellow LED: permanently on: indicates the presence of an object or disturbing object within
the sensing range
- disconnect the Teach-input wire from -UB and the changing is saved
Series
-F12
2. Wide angle sound cone
• switch off the power supply
• connect the Teach-input wire with +UB
• switch on the power supply
Series
-F42
• the red LED double-flashes with a long pause before the next. pause
• yellow LED: permanently on: indicates an object or disturbing object within the sensing
range
• disconnect the Teach-input wire from +UB and the changing is saved
Series
-F43
UB...-18GM75-..., output type -F (frequency output)
Series
-F54
Parameter assignment of the signal output
The ultrasonic sensor is equipped with a signal output that represents the distance determined to the object in the form of a frequency propor-
tional to the distance of the object. The current path characteristic of this output signal follows a zero-point straight line, i.e. The extrapolated
output frequency for the object distance 0 (which is not usable in practical terms) also corresponds to 0. As the object distance increases, the
Series
-F64
output frequency also increases.
The object distance can be calculated according to:
Series
-D1
If no object is detected, the level 1 is permanently present on the output.
The frequency of the output channel is adjusted by the gain of the output characteristic line.
Wiring arrangement of the pa- Gain of the output cha-
rameterisation input racteristic line
Series
LUC
-UB 2 Hz/mm
Not used 1 Hz/mm
+UB 4 Hz/mm
Double sheet
monitoring
The sensor checks the parameterisation input when the operating voltage is switched on. A change in the wiring of the parameterisation input
during ongoing operation has no effect on the signal output.
LED display
The sensor is equipped with 2 LEDs. Their meaning is as follows:
LED green: Operating voltage applied
Power supplies
Control units/
Synchronisation
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor will operate using
an internally generated clock rate. The synchronisation of multiple sensors can be implemented as follows:
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
External synchronisation
The sensor can be synchronised by the external application of a square wave voltage. A synchronisation pulse at the synchronisation input
Accessories
starts a measuring cycle. The pulse must have a duration greater than 100 µs. The measuring cycle starts with the falling edge of a synchro-
nisation pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input results in normal operation of the sensor. A high level at the synchronisation
input disables the sensor.
Two operating modes are available
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 61
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
1) Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors work on the same clock rate.
2) The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to only one sensor at a time. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
-18GK/-18GM
Internal synchronisation
Series
The synchronisation connections of up to 5 sensors capable of internal synchronisation are connected to one another. When power is applied,
these sensors operate in multiplex mode. The response delay increases according to the number of sensors to be synchronised.
Note
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input should be connected with ground (0 V) or the sensor should be operated
with a V1 cable connector (4-pin).
Series
-30GM
Object distance [mm] = 2 * sensing r ange [mm] * pulse length [s] * frequency [Hz]
Series
If the object distance reaches or exceeds twice the nominal detection range, or if no object is detected, a level 1 is permanently present on the
-F12
output.
The frequency of the output channel is adjusted by the wiring arrangement of the parameterisation input.
Wiring arrangement of the parameteri- Output frequency
sation input
Series
-F42
-UB 30 Hz
Not used 245 Hz
+UB 1900 Hz
The sensor checks the parameterisation input when the operating voltage is switched on. A change in the wiring of the parameterisation input
Series
-F43
Synchronisation
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor will operate using
an internally generated clock rate. The synchronisation of multiple sensors can be implemented as follows:
Series
External synchronisation
-F64
The sensor can be synchronised by the external application of a square wave voltage. A synchronisation pulse at the synchronisation input
starts a measuring cycle. The pulse must have a duration greater than 100 µs. The measuring cycle starts with the falling edge of a synchro-
nisation pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input results in normal operation of the sensor. A high level at the synchronisation
input disables the sensor.
Series
1) Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors work on the same clock rate.
2) The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to only one sensor at a time. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
Internal synchronisation
The synchronisation connections of up to 5 sensors capable of internal synchronisation are connected to one another. When power is applied,
Series
these sensors operate in multiplex mode. The response delay increases according to the number of sensors to be synchronised.
LUC
Note
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input should be connected with ground (0 V) or the sensor should be operated
with a V1 cable connector (4-pin).
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
62 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -18GK/-18GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UB...-18GM75-..., output type -BIT (digital value)
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Parameter assignment of the signal output
The ultrasonic sensor is equipped with a signal output that represents the distance determined to the object in the form of a digital value pro-
portional to the distance of the object. The current path characteristic of this output signal follows a zero-point straight line, i.e. The extrapolated
digital value for the object distance 0 (which is not usable in practical terms) also corresponds to 0. As the object distance increases, the digital
value also increases. The digital value is generated serially. A word consists of 1 start bit (level 1), 12 data bits (value), and 1 stop bit (level 0).
Series
-30GM
The object distance can be calculated according to:
VariKont
Series
If no object is detected, a level 1 is permanently present on the output.
The bit width is adjusted by the wiring arrangement of the parameterisation input.
Wiring arrangement of the parameteri- Bit width
sation input
-UB 50 µs
Series
-FP
Not used 100 µs
+UB 200 µs
The sensor checks the parameterisation input when the operating voltage is switched on. A change in the wiring of the parameterisation input
during ongoing operation has no effect on the signal output.
Series
-F12
LED display
The sensor is equipped with 2 LEDs. Their meaning is as follows:
LED green: Operating voltage applied
LED red: No object detected
Series
-F42
Synchronisation
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor will operate using
an internally generated clock rate. The synchronisation of multiple sensors can be implemented as follows:
External synchronisation
Series
-F43
The sensor can be synchronised by the external application of a square wave voltage. A synchronisation pulse at the synchronisation input
starts a measuring cycle. The pulse must have a duration greater than 100 µs. The measuring cycle starts with the falling edge of a synchro-
nisation pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input results in normal operation of the sensor. A high level at the synchronisation
input disables the sensor.
Two operating modes are available
Series
-F54
1) Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors work on the same clock rate.
2) T he synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to only one sensor at a time. T he sensors operate in multiplex mode.
Internal synchronisation
The synchronisation connections of up to 5 sensors capable of internal synchronisation are connected to one another. When power is applied,
these sensors operate in multiplex mode. The response delay increases according to the number of sensors to be synchronised.
Series
-F64
Note
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input should be connected with ground (0 V) or the sensor should be operated
with a V1 cable connector (4-pin).
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 63
Series -30GM
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
64 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -30GM
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Model number Description Detection range Page
Comfort design (with RS 232 serial interface)
UC300-30GM-IUR2-V15 300 mm 66
Series
-F12
UC300-30GM-E6R2-K-V15 for installation in confined spaces 300 mm 68
UC300-30GM-E7R2-K-V15
UC300-30GM-IUR2-K-V15
UC500-30GM-E6R2-V15 500 mm 70
Series
-F42
UC500-30GM-E7R2-V15
UC500-30GM-IUR2-V15
UC1000-30GM-E6R2-K-V15 for installation in confined spaces 1000 mm 72
UC1000-30GM-IUR2-K-V15
Series
-F43
UCC1000-30GM-E6R2-V15 with chemical resistant transducer coating 1000 mm 74
UCC1000-30GM-IUR2-V15
UC2000-30GM-E6R2-V15 2000 mm 76
UC2000-30GM-E7R2-V15
Series
-F54
UC2000-30GM-IUR2-V15
UC2000-30GM-E6R2-T-V15 extended temperature range 2000 mm 78
UC2000-30GM-E7R2-T-V15
UC2000-30GM-IUR2-T-V15
Series
-F64
UC4000-30GM-E6R2-V15 4000 mm 80
UC4000-30GM-E7R2-V15
UC4000-30GM-IUR2-V15
UC6000-30GM-E6R2-V15 6000 mm 82
UC6000-30GM-E7R2-V15
Series
-D1
UC6000-30GM-IUR2-V15
Basic design
UBE4000-30GM-SA2-V15 Ultrasonic through beam barrier 4000 mm 84
Series
LUC
UB500-30GM-E4-V15 500 mm 86
UB500-30GM-E5-V15 500 mm
UB2000-30GM-E4-V15 2000 mm
UB2000-30GM-E5-V15 2000 mm
Double sheet
monitoring
UB4000-30GM-E4-V15 4000 mm 88
UB4000-30GM-E5-V15 4000 mm
UB6000-30GM-E4-V15 6000 mm
UB6000-30GM-E5-V15 6000 mm
Power supplies
Control units/
UB6000-30GM-H3-V1 6000 mm
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 65
Ultrasonic sensor UC300-30GM-IUR2-V15
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC300-30GM-IUR2-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional !
0 level -UB...+1 V
1 level: +4 V...+UB
input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Double sheet
monitoring
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
66 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC300-30GM-IUR2-V15
-12GM
Series
M30x1.5
-18GK/-18GM
Series
5
36
Series
-30GM
114
VariKont
Series
22
Series
-FP
LED
27.5
Temperature probe
Coded plug
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
(version IU)
Series
-F43
1 (BN)
+ UB
U 5 (GY)
Sync.
2 (WH)
0-10 V
4 (BK)
4-20 mA
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
0.20
Near distance Far distance
0.15 of evaluation of evaluation
0.10 20 mA/10 V
1 1) 4 mA/
0.05
2 0V
Power supplies
0.00
Control units/
20 mA/
-0.05
10 V
2)
-0.10
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-0.15 4 mA/0 V
-0.20 20 mA/10 V
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Distance X [m]
3) 4 mA/
Y
0V
Accessories
X
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
A1= 0 mm A2
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 67
Ultrasonic sensor UC300-30GM-...-K-V15
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC300-30GM-E6R2-K-V15
UC300-30GM-E7R2-K-V15
UC300-30GM-IUR2-K-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional ! ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V, 1 level: +4 V...+UB , input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 95 Hz ! ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 95/n Hz, n = number of sensors ! ! !
Interface type RS 232, 9600 Bit/s , no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
68 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC300-30GM-...-K-V15
-12GM
Series
5 5
-18GK/-18GM
Series
M30x1.5
M30x1.5
LED LED
22 22
Series
-30GM
27.5 112 27.5 93.5
4 4
VariKont
1.5 m 1.5 m
Series
24 24
M18x1
M18x1
26 26
Series
-FP
output version -IUE2 output version -E6R2 and -E7R2
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB
5 (GY) + UB 2 (WH)
Sync. U 5 (GY)
U Switch output 1
U 2 (WH) Sync. 4 (BK)
Switch output 2
Switch output 1 2 (WH)
4 (BK) 0-10 V 5 (GY)
Switch output 2 4 (BK) Sync.
3 (BU) 4-20 mA 3 (BU) - UB
- UB 3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curve Programmed analogue output function Possible operating modes
1. Switch point mode
Distance Y [m]
Analogue function When A1 < A2, both switch outputs are activated as
0.20 N.O. contacts.
Near distance Far distance
Series
0.15 of evaluation of evaluation Switch point 1 Switch point 2
-D1
0.10 20 mA/10 V A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
1 1) 4 mA/
0.05
2 0V A 2 (N.O.)
0.00 Switch output 2
20 mA/
Series
LUC
-0.05
10 V
2) When A1 > A2, both switch outputs are activated as
-0.10 N.C. contacts.
-0.15 4 mA/0 V A 1 (N.C.)
Switch output 1
Double sheet
20 mA/10 V
monitoring
-0.20
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Distance X [m]
3) 4 mA/ A2 (N.C.)
Y
0V Switch output 2
X
2. Window mode
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
A1= 0 mm A2
A 1 (N.O.)
Power supplies
Control units/
Switch output 1
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
3. Hysteresis mode
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
Accessories
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 69
Ultrasonic sensor UC500-30GM-...-V15
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC500-30GM-E6R2-V15
UC500-30GM-E7R2-V15
UC500-30GM-IUR2-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional ! ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V, 1 level: +4 V...+UB , input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 95 Hz ! ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 95/n Hz, n = number of sensors ! ! !
Interface type RS 232, 9600 Bit/s , no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Mass 140 g ! !
170 g !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
70 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC500-30GM-...-V15
-12GM
Series
M30x1.5 M30x1.5
-18GK/-18GM
Series
5
5
36 36
94
Series
-30GM
114
22
VariKont
Series
22
LED
27.5
Temperature probe
Coded plug
LED
27.5
Series
-FP
Temperature probe
Coded plug
Series
-F12
output versions -E6R2 and -E7R 2 output version -IUR2
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB
5 (GY) + UB 2 (WH)
Sync. U 5 (GY)
U Switch output 1
U 2 (WH) Sync. 4 (BK)
Switch output 2
Switch output 1 2 (WH)
4 (BK) 0-10 V 5 (GY)
Switch output 2 4 (BK) Sync.
3 (BU) 4-20 mA 3 (BU) - UB
- UB 3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curve Programmed analogue output function Possible operating modes
1. Switch point mode
Distance Y [m]
Analogue function When A1 < A2, both switch outputs are activated as
0.20 N.O. contacts.
Near distance Far distance
0.15 of evaluation of evaluation Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Series
-D1
0.10 20 mA/10 V A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
1 1) 4 mA/
0.05
2 0V A 2 (N.O.)
0.00 Switch output 2
20 mA/
Series
-0.05
LUC
10 V
2) When A1 > A2, both switch outputs are activated as
-0.10 N.C. contacts.
-0.15 4 mA/0 V A 1 (N.C.)
Switch output 1
20 mA/10 V
Double sheet
-0.20
monitoring
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Distance X [m]
3) 4 mA/ A2 (N.C.)
Y
0V Switch output 2
X
2. Window mode
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
A1= 0 mm A2
A 1 (N.O.)
Power supplies
Switch output 1
Control units/
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
3. Hysteresis mode
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
A2 (N.C.)
Accessories
Switch output 2
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 71
Ultrasonic sensor UC1000-30GM-..R2-K-V15
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC1000-30GM-E6R2-K-V15
UC1000-30GM-IUR2-K-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional ! !
monitoring
Mass 210 g !
260 g !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
72 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC1000-30GM-..R2-K-V15
-12GM
Series
5
Temperature probe
Coded plug 36
-18GK/-18GM
Series
M30x1.5
Series
-30GM
LED
22
27.5 112
VariKont
Series
5
1.5 m 36
Series
-FP
M30x1.5
Series
-F12
26
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
-F43
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN)
5 (GY) + UB
Sync. U 5 (GY)
U 2 (WH) Sync.
Switch output 1 2 (WH)
4 (BK) 0-10 V
Switch output 2 4 (BK)
3 (BU)
- UB 4-20 mA
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curve Programmed analogue output function Possible operating modes
1. Switch point mode
Distance Y [m]
Analogue function When A1 < A2, both switch outputs are activated as
0.6 N.O. contacts.
Near distance Far distance
0.4 of evaluation of evaluation Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Series
-D1
20 mA/10 V A 1 (N.O.)
0.2 Switch output 1
1) 4 mA/
0.0 0V A 2 (N.O.)
2 1 Switch output 2
-0.2 20 mA/
Series
10 V
LUC
-0.4 2) When A1 > A2, both switch outputs are activated as
N.C. contacts.
-0.6 4 mA/0 V A 1 (N.C.)
Switch output 1
20 mA/10 V
Double sheet
-0.8
monitoring
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
3. Hysteresis mode
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
A2 (N.C.)
Accessories
Switch output 2
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 73
Ultrasonic sensor UCC1000-30GM-..R2-V15
-12GM
Series
• Synchronisation options
• Adjustable acoustic power and sensitivity
• Temperature compensation
• Current and voltage output
Series
-30GM
UCC1000-30GM-IUR2-V15
• 2 switch outputs freely adjustable
UCC1000-30GM-E6R2-V15
• Hysteresis mode selectable
VariKont
Series
UCC1000-30GM-E6R2-V15
• Window function can be selected
UCC1000-30GM-E6R2-V15
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UCC1000-30GM-E6R2-V15
UCC1000-30GM-IUR2-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V, 1 level: +4 V...+UB , input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 30 Hz ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 30/n Hz, n = number of sensors ! !
Interface type RS 232, 9600 Bit/s , no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! !
Ambient temperature 0 ... 70 °C (273 ... 343 K) ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
170 g !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
74 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UCC1000-30GM-..R2-V15
-12GM
Series
ø32 ø32
-18GK/-18GM
13.5
13.5
Series
5
5
96
Series
-30GM
36 36
115
VariKont
Series
LED
Temperature probe
Coded plug
LED
M30x1.5
Series
Temperature probe
-FP
Coded plug
M30x1.5
Series
-F12
output version -E6R2 output version -IUR2
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
-F43
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN)
5 (GY) + UB
Sync. U 5 (GY)
U 2 (WH) Sync.
Switch output 1 2 (WH)
4 (BK) 0-10 V
Switch output 2 4 (BK)
3 (BU)
- UB 4-20 mA
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curves Programmed switching output function Programmed analogue output function
90 80 70 60 50 40 30 Position of insert
monitoring
0.0 2 1
0 A 2 (N.O.)
20 mA/
Switch output 2
10 V
0.5 -10
2)
A 1 (N.O.)
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Switch output 1
4 mA/0 V
1.0
-20
E3
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
1.5 -30
2.0 2.5 3.0
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 75
Ultrasonic sensor UC2000-30GM-...-V15
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC2000-30GM-E6R2-V15
UC2000-30GM-E7R2-V15
UC2000-30GM-IUR2-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional ! ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V, 1 level: +4 V...+UB , input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 30 Hz ! ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 30/n Hz, n = number of sensors ! ! !
Interface type RS 232, 9600 Bit/s , no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Mass 140 g ! !
170 g !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
76 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC2000-30GM-...-V15
-12GM
Series
M30x1.5 M30x1.5
-18GK/-18GM
Series
5
5
36 36
94
Series
-30GM
114
22
VariKont
Series
22
LED
27.5
Temperature probe
Coded plug
LED
27.5
Series
-FP
Temperature probe
Coded plug
Series
output versions -E6R2 and -E7R2 output version -IUR2
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
1 (BN) + UB + UB 1 (BN)
5 (GY) 2 (WH) + UB
Sync. U Switch output 1 U 5 (GY)
U 2 (WH) 4 (BK)
Switch output 2 Sync.
Switch output 1 2 (WH)
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 0-10 V
Switch output 2 Sync. 4 (BK)
3 (BU) 3 (BU) - UB 4-20 mA
- UB 3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curve Programmed analogue output function Possible operating modes
1. Switch point mode
Distance Y [m]
Analogue function When A1 < A2, both switch outputs are activated as
0.6 N.O. contacts.
Near distance Far distance
0.4 of evaluation of evaluation Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Series
-D1
20 mA/10 V A 1 (N.O.)
0.2 Switch output 1
1) 4 mA/
0.0 0V A 2 (N.O.)
2 1 Switch output 2
-0.2 20 mA/
Series
LUC
10 V
-0.4 2) When A1 > A2, both switch outputs are activated as
N.C. contacts.
-0.6 4 mA/0 V A 1 (N.C.)
Switch output 1
20 mA/10 V
Double sheet
-0.8
monitoring
Switch output 1
Control units/
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
3. Hysteresis mode
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
A2 (N.C.)
Accessories
Switch output 2
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 77
Ultrasonic sensor UC2000-30GM-...-T-V15
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC2000-30GM-E6R2-T-V15
UC2000-30GM-E7R2-T-V15
UC2000-30GM-IUR2-T-V1 5
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional ! ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V, 1 level: +4 V...+UB , input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 30 Hz ! ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 30/n Hz, n = number of sensors ! ! !
Interface type RS 232, 9600 Bit/s , no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Mass 180 g ! !
210 g !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
78 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC2000-30GM-...-T-V15
-12GM
Series
ø40 ø40
-18GK/-18GM
25
25
Series
5
108
Series
-30GM
128
36 36
VariKont
Series
22
LED
22
27.5
Temperature probe
Series
Coded plug
-FP
LED
27.5
M30x1.5
Temperature probe
Coded plug
M30x1.5
Series
-F12
output version -IUR2 output versions -E6R2 and -E7R2
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
1 (BN) + UB + UB 1 (BN)
5 (GY) 2 (WH) + UB
Sync. U Switch output 1 U 5 (GY)
U 2 (WH) 4 (BK)
Switch output 2 Sync.
Switch output 1 2 (WH)
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 0-10 V
Switch output 2 Sync. 4 (BK)
3 (BU) 3 (BU) - UB 4-20 mA
- UB 3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curve Programmed analogue output function Possible operating modes
1. Switch point mode
Distance Y [m]
Analogue function When A1 < A2, both switch outputs are activated as
0.6 N.O. contacts.
Near distance Far distance
0.4 of evaluation of evaluation Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Series
-D1
20 mA/10 V A 1 (N.O.)
0.2 Switch output 1
1) 4 mA/
0.0 0V A 2 (N.O.)
2 1 Switch output 2
-0.2 20 mA/
Series
LUC
10 V
-0.4 2) When A1 > A2, both switch outputs are activated as
N.C. contacts.
-0.6 4 mA/0 V A 1 (N.C.)
Switch output 1
20 mA/10 V
Double sheet
-0.8
monitoring
Switch output 1
Control units/
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
3. Hysteresis mode
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
A2 (N.C.)
Accessories
Switch output 2
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 79
Ultrasonic sensor UC4000-30GM-...-V15
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC4000-30GM-E6R2-V15
UC4000-30GM-E7R2-V15
UC4000-30GM-IUR2-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional ! ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V, 1 level: +4 V...+UB , input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 13 Hz ! ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 13/n Hz, n = number of sensors ! ! !
Interface type RS 232, 9600 Bit/s , no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Mass 180 g ! !
210 g !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
80 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC4000-30GM-...-V15
-12GM
Series
ø40 ø40
-18GK/-18GM
25
25
Series
5
108
Series
-30GM
128
36 36
VariKont
Series
22
LED
22
27.5
Temperature probe
Series
Coded plug
-FP
LED
27.5
M30x1.5
Temperature probe
Coded plug
M30x1.5
Series
-F12
output version -IUR2 output versions -E6R2 and E7R2
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
1 (BN) + UB + UB 1 (BN)
5 (GY) 2 (WH) + UB
Sync. U Switch output 1 U 5 (GY)
U 2 (WH) 4 (BK)
Switch output 2 Sync.
Switch output 1 2 (WH)
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 0-10 V
Switch output 2 Sync. 4 (BK)
3 (BU) 3 (BU) - UB 4-20 mA
- UB 3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curve Programmed analogue output function Possible operating modes
1. Switch point mode
Distance Y [m]
Analogue function When A1 < A2, both switch outputs are activated as
1.5 N.O. contacts.
Near distance Far distance
of evaluation of evaluation Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Series
1.0
-D1
20 mA/10 V A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
0.5 1) 4 mA/
2 1 0V A 2 (N.O.)
0.0 Switch output 2
20 mA/
Series
LUC
-0.5 10 V
2) When A1 > A2, both switch outputs are activated as
N.C. contacts.
-1.0
4 mA/0 V A 1 (N.C.)
Switch output 1
20 mA/10 V
Double sheet
-1.5
monitoring
0,0 0,5 1,0 1,5 2,0 2,5 3,0 3,5 4,0 4,5 5,0 5,5 6,0 6,5
Distance X [m]
3) 4 mA/ A2 (N.C.)
Y
0V Switch output 2
X
2. Window mode
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
A1= 0 mm A2
A 1 (N.O.)
Power supplies
Switch output 1
Control units/
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
3. Hysteresis mode
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
A2 (N.C.)
Accessories
Switch output 2
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 81
Ultrasonic sensor UC6000-30GM-...-V15
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC6000-30GM-E6R2-V15
UC6000-30GM-E7R2-V15
UC6000-30GM-IUR2-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Synchronisation bi-directional ! ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V, 1 level: +4 V...+UB , input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 7 Hz ! ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 7/n Hz, n = number of sensors ! ! !
Interface type RS 232, 9600 Bit/s , no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit ! ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Mass 270 g ! !
280 g !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
82 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC6000-30GM-...-V15
-12GM
Series
ø73 ø73
-18GK/-18GM
19
19
Series
32.5
32.5
5
Series
-30GM
112
132
36 36
VariKont
Series
22
22
LED
27.5
Series
-FP
Temperature probe
Coded plug
LED
27.5
M30x1.5
temperature probe
coded plug
M30x1.5
Series
-F12
output versions -E6R2 and -E7R2 output version -IUR2
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
1 (BN) + UB + UB 1 (BN)
5 (GY) 2 (WH) + UB
Sync. U Switch output 1 U 5 (GY)
U 2 (WH) 4 (BK)
Switch output 2 Sync.
Switch output 1 2 (WH)
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 0-10 V
Switch output 2 Sync. 4 (BK)
3 (BU) 3 (BU) - UB 4-20 mA
- UB 3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
-F64
Characteristic response curve Programmed analogue output function Possible operating modes
1. Switch point mode
Distance Y [m]
Analogue function When A1 < A2, both switch outputs are activated as
1.5 N.O. contacts.
Near distance Far distance
of evaluation of evaluation Switch point 1 Switch point 2
Series
1.0
-D1
1 20 mA/10 V A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
0.5 1) 4 mA/
2 0V A 2 (N.O.)
0.0 Switch output 2
20 mA/
Series
LUC
-0.5 10 V
2) When A1 > A2, both switch outputs are activated as
N.C. contacts.
-1.0 4 mA/0 V A 1 (N.C.)
Switch output 1
20 mA/10 V
Double sheet
-1.5
monitoring
0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0
Distance X [m]
3) 4 mA/ A2 (N.C.)
Y
0V Switch output 2
X
2. Window mode
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
A1= 0 mm A2
A 1 (N.O.)
Power supplies
Switch output 1
Control units/
A2 (N.C.)
Switch output 2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
3. Hysteresis mode
To exchange the switching distances is of no effect.
A 1 (N.O.)
Switch output 1
A2 (N.C.)
Accessories
Switch output 2
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 83
Through-beam ultrasonic barrier UBE4000-30GM-SA2-V15
-12GM
Series
• Protective functions
• Emitter and receiver included in the delivery package
• Adjustable acoustic power
• Adjustable switch-on delay
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
U
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UBE4000-30GM-SA2-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
≤ 15 Hz
-F64
Switching frequency !
Switch-on delay 100 ... 3000 ms !
Standards EN 60947-5-2 !
C-UL listed: 57M3, IND CONT. EQ., "Powered by Class 2 Power Source"
Ambient temperature 0 ... 60 °C (273 ... 333 K) !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) !
Series
-D1
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
84 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UBE4000-30GM-SA2-V15
-12GM
Series
Dimensions:
Threaded pipe M30x1.5
-18GK/-18GM
Series
ø40
Series
-30GM
25 22
90
VariKont
Series
Emitter: Receiver:
Dual-LED
LED green green/yellow
Series
-FP
internal distance regulator Potentiometer
Plug connector Plug connector
ON delay
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
(version A2, pnp)
Series
-F43
Receiver:
1 (BN)
+UB
2 (WH)
U 4 (BK)
N.O. N.C.
5 n.c.
3 (BU) -UB
Series
-F54
Emitter:
1 (BN)
+UB
2 (WH) 10k
Series
U
-F64
4 (BK)
5 n.c.
3 (BU) -UB
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
10
Power supplies
Control units/
0.0 0
0.5
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
1.0 -10
1.5
-20
2.0
2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 85
Ultrasonic sensor UB...-30GM-..-V15
-12GM
Series
• Switch output
• 5 different output functions can be set
-18GK/-18GM
• TEACH-IN input
Series
• Synchronisation options
• Deactivation option
• Temperature compensation
• Insensitive to compressed air
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB2000-30GM-E4-V15
UB2000-30GM-E5-V15
UB500-30GM-E4-V15
UB500-30GM-E5-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
0 ... 80 mm ! !
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm ! ! ! !
Transducer frequency approx. 180 kHz ! !
approx. 380 kHz ! !
Response delay approx. 150 ms ! !
Series
-F54
approx. 50 ms ! !
LED green permanent: Power-on ! ! ! !
flashing: TEACH-IN function object detected
LED yellow permanent: switching state switch output ! ! ! !
flashing: TEACH-IN function
LED red normal operation: "fault" ! ! ! !
Series
-F64
Synchronisation bi-directional ! ! ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V
1 level: +4 V...+UB
input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 30 Hz ! !
≤ 95 Hz
Power supplies
! !
Control units/
Material
Housing brass, nickel-plated, plastic components PBT ! ! ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam ! ! ! !
Mass 135 g ! !
140 g ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
86 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB...-30GM-..-V15
-12GM
Series
M30x1.5
-18GK/-18GM
Series
5
36
Series
-30GM
94
VariKont
Series
22
LED
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN) 1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB + UB
4 (BK) 2 (WH)
Switch output Teaching input
U 2 (WH) U 5 (GY)
Teaching input Synchronous
5 (GY) 4 (BK)
Synchronous Switch output
3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function
1. Window mode, normally open function
Distance Y [m] Distance Y [m]
Double sheet
0.20 0.6
A1 A2
0.15 0.4
2. Window mode, normally closed function
0.10
0.2 A2 < A1:
1
0.05 A2 A1
0.0
2
Power supplies
0.00 1
-0.2 A1 -> ∞:
-0.05
-0.4 A2
-0.10
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-0.20 -0.8 A1
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0
Y Distance X [m] Y Distance X [m]
5. A1 -> ∞, A2 -> ∞: Detection of object presence
Accessories
UB500-30GM-... UB2000-30GM-...
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 87
Ultrasonic sensor UB...-30GM-..-V15
-12GM
Series
• Switch output
• 5 different output functions can be set
-18GK/-18GM
• TEACH-IN input
Series
• Synchronisation options
• Deactivation option
• Temperature compensation
• Insensitive to compressed air
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB4000-30GM-E4-V15
UB4000-30GM-E5-V15
UB6000-30GM-E4-V15
UB6000-30GM-E5-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
0 ... 350 mm ! !
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm ! ! ! !
Transducer frequency approx. 65 kHz ! !
approx. 85 kHz ! !
Response delay approx. 325 ms ! !
Series
-F54
approx. 650 ms ! !
LED green permanent: Power-on ! ! ! !
flashing: TEACH-IN function object detected
LED yellow permanent: switching state switch output ! ! ! !
flashing: TEACH-IN function
LED red normal operation: "fault" ! ! ! !
Series
-F64
Synchronisation bi-directional ! ! ! !
0 level -UB...+1 V
1 level: +4 V...+UB
input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Common mode operation ≤ 13 Hz ! !
≤ 7 Hz
Power supplies
! !
Control units/
Material
Housing brass, nickel-plated, plastic components PBT ! ! ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam ! ! ! !
Mass 180 g ! !
250 g ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
88 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB...-30GM-..-V15
-12GM
Series
ø40 ø73
-18GK/-18GM
19
25
Series
32.5
5
Series
-30GM
108
112
36
36
VariKont
Series
22
22
LED
LED
M30x1.5
M30x1.5
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
UB4000-30GM-... UB6000-30GM-...
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN) 1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB + UB
4 (BK) 2 (WH)
Switch output Teaching input
U 2 (WH) U 5 (GY)
Teaching input Synchronous
5 (GY) 4 (BK)
Synchronous Switch output
3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function
1. Window mode, normally open function
Distance Y [m] Distance Y [m]
Double sheet
1.5 1.5
A1 A2
1.0 1.0
2. Window mode, normally closed function
1 A2 < A1:
0.5 0.5
A2 A1
2 1 2
Power supplies
0.0 0.0
A1 -> ∞:
-0.5 -0.5 A2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-1.5 -1.5 A1
0,0 0,5 1,0 1,5 2,0 2,5 3,0 3,5 4,0 4,5 5,0 5,5 6,0 6,5 0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0
Y Distance X [m] Y Distance X [m]
5. A1 -> ∞, A2 -> ∞: Detection of object presence
Accessories
UB4000-30GM-... UB6000-30GM-...
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 89
Ultrasonic sensor UB...-30GM-H3-V1
-12GM
Series
• Separate evaluation
• Direct detection mode
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB2000-30GM-H3-V1
UB4000-30GM-H3-V1
UB6000-30GM-H3-V1
UB500-30GM-H3-V1
Model number
Series
-F42
!
0 ... 350 mm 1)
!
0 ... 80 mm 1)
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm ! ! ! !
Transducer frequency approx. [kHz] 380 180 85 65
Operating voltage 10 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS ! ! ! !
Series
-F64
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 85 °C (248 ... 358 K) ! ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! ! !
Protection degree IP67 ! ! ! !
Connection V1 connector (M12 x 1), 4-pin ! ! ! !
Power supplies
250 g !
Fun ction
The sensing range is determined in the downstream evaluation electronics (e. g. the units UH3-KHD2-4E5, UH3-KHD2-4I or UH3-T1-KT). PLC modules or other
existing evaluation units can also be substituted for these units offered by Pepperl+F uchs.
Accessories
The object distance in pulse-echo mode is obtained from the echo time.
1)
The unusable area (blind range) BR depends on the pulse duration Ti .
The unusable area reaches a minimum with the shortest pulse duration.
2)
The sensors detection range depends on the pulse duration Ti.
With pulse duration < typical pulse duration, the sensors detection range may be reduced.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
90 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB...-30GM-H3-V1
-12GM
Series
M30 x 1.5 ø40 ø74
-18GK/-18GM
19
25
32.5
Series
60
74
80
80
90
5
95
100
105
110
36
Series
-30GM
36
M12 x 1
VariKont
Series
M12 x 1
M12 x 1
M30 x 1.5
M30 x 1.5
Series
-FP
UB500-... and UB2000-... UB4000-... UB6000-...
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB
2 (WH)
U Clock
4 (BK)
Echo
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
2 = Emitter pulse input
-F54
4 = Echo propagation time output
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curves Characteristic response curves Characteristic response curves Characteristic response curves
Distance Y [m] Distance Y [m] Distance Y [m]
1.5 4
Double sheet
3
monitoring
Distance Y [m]
0.3 3
1
2
0.2 2
0.5 1
0.1 1
1
0 0 0 -0
2 2 1 2 1 2 1
-0.1 -1
-0.5 -1
Power supplies
Control units/
-0.2 -2
-2
-1
-0.3 -3
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
-3
-4
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 91
Series -30GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
T Temperature compensation
• Plug and remove the TEACH-IN plug in pos. A1 or A2. This teaches the evaluation limits A1 or A2.
Caution: Removing the temperature/TEACH-IN plug, the values of the object position will be adopted.
• The TEACH-IN procedure is controlled with the LED. The green LED flashes, when object is detected, the red LED flashes
when no object is detected.
Series
-F42
• Connect TEACH-IN plug in pos. T. This completes the TEACH-IN procedure and saves the distance.
• The sensor works in normal mode
TEACH-IN the analogue function
Series
quence:
1) r ising ramp, LED A2 flashes,
2) falling ramp, LED A1 flashes,
3) zero line, LED A1 and A2 flash
Series
• Connect TEACH-IN plug in pos. T. This completes the TEACH-IN procedure and saves the mode of operation.
-F64
Synchronisation
-D1
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor will operate using an internally
generated clock rate. It can be synchronised by applying a square wave voltage. A falling edge leads to the transmission of a single ultrasonic pulse. A
low level ≥ 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in t he normal operation of the sensor.
Series
A high level > 1 s will result in the standby mode of the sensor (indicator green LED). The out puts pause in the lat est status.
LUC
1. Two t o five sensors can be synchronised by interconnecting their synchronisation inputs. In this case, the sensors alternately transmit ultrasonic pulses.
monitoring
2. Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors are synchronised.
3. The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to individual sensors. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
4. A high level at the synchronisation input disables the sensor.
The response time increases when the sensor is synchronised, because the synchronisation increases the measurement cycle time.
Power supplies
Control units/
Note:
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input has to be connected to ground (0V) or the sensor has to be operated via a V1 cable
connector (4-pin).
Date of edi ti on 0 8/17/20 05
Default setting
A1: unusable area
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
92 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -30GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
LED Displays/Analogue output
-18GK/-18GM
Displays in dependence on operating Dual Dual- LED LED analogue out-
Series
mode LED LED yellow A1 yellow A2 put
green red
TEACH-IN evaluation limit A1 unchanged
object detected flashing off flashing off
object not detected off flashing flashing off
Series
-30GM
TEACH-IN evaluation limit A2 unchanged
object detected flashing off off flashing
object not detected off flashing off flashing
TEACH-IN mode of operation (E2/E3) unchanged
VariKont
Series
rising ramp on off off flashing
falling ramp on off flashing off
zero line on off flashing (syn- flashing (syn-
chronised) chronised)
Normal mode on, if target in on, if target in analogue value
Series
-FP
temperature compensated on off evaluation detection range
plug pulled/shorted off on range
Standby flashing off previous state previous st ate unchanged
Interference (e.g. compressed air) off flashing previous state previous st ate unchanged or
Series
error value
-F12
LED-Window RS 232-connection
LED Dual-LED LED Groove V15-plug connector
Series
yellow green/red yellow
-F42
(M12x1)
Temperature/program
connector
(PC connection via inter- 4 1
E2 E3 face cable UC-30GM-R2)
3 2
1: TXD
A1 A2 2: RXD
Series
Evaluation limit 1 Evaluation limit 2 3: not used
-F43
LED-window
"Power on"/Disturbance 4: GND
Series
-F54
gram plug on the sensor. When setting up the connection on the sensor, make certain the plug is lined up correctly; otherwise
no communication will be possible. The protrusion of the round plug must be inserted into the groove of the plug connection
on the sensor side and not into the arrow symbol on the sensor.
Adjustable parameter with service program ULTRA 2001
Series
-F64
• Evaluation limits A1 and A2
• Rising/falling ramp/zero line
• Mode of operation
Series
• Sonic speed
-D1
• Temperature offset (The inherent temperature-rise of the sensor can be considered in the temperature compensation)
• Expansion of the unusable area (for suppression of unusable area echoes)
• Reduction of the detection range (for suppression of remote range echoes)
Series
LUC
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 93
Series -30GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
T Temperature compensation
quence:
-F54
• Connect TEACH-IN plug in pos. T. The TEACH-IN procedure is completed, the sensor is working in normal mode.
-F64
Note: If the temperature/TEACH-IN plug has not been plugged in within 5 minutes in position T, the sensor will return to normal
mode (with the latest permanent stored values) without temperature compensation.
Synchronisation
Series
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor will operate using an internally
-D1
generated clock rate. It can be synchronised by applying a square wave voltage. A falling edge leads to the transmission of a single ultrasonic pulse. A
low level ≥ 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in t he normal operation of the sensor.
A high level > 1 s will result in the standby mode of the sensor (indicator green LED). The out puts pause in the lat est status.
Series
2. Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors are synchronised.
monitoring
3. The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to individual sensors. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
4. A high level at the synchronisation input disables the sensor.
The response time increases when the sensor is synchronised, because the synchronisation increases the measurement cycle time.
Note:
Power supplies
Control units/
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input has to be connected to ground (0V) or the sensor has to be operated via a V1 cable
connector (4-pin).
Default setting
Date of edi ti on 0 9/13/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
94 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -30GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
LED Displays
-18GK/-18GM
Displays in dependence on operating Dual LED LED LED LED
Series
mode green red yellow A1 yellow A2
TEACH-IN of swit ching point A1
object detected flashing off flashing off
no object detected off flashing flashing off
Series
-30GM
TEACH-IN switching point A2
object detected flashing off off flashing
no object detected off flashing off flashing
TEACH-IN mode of operation (E2/E3)
VariKont
Series
two independent switching points on off flashing off
window mode on off off flashing
Hysteresis mode on off flashing flashing
Normal mode
Series
temperature compensated on off switching state A1 switching state A2
-FP
plug pulled or shorted off on switching state A1 switching state A2
Interference (e.g. compressed air) off flashing last or defined condi- last or defined condi-
tion tion
Series
-F12
Standby flashes off previous state previous state
LED ON indicates closed switch output.
Series
-F42
LED-Window RS 232-connection
LED Dual-LED LED Groove V15-plug connector
yellow green/red yellow (M12x1)
Temperature/program
connector
(PC connection via inter- 4 1
E2 E3 face cable UC-30GM-R2)
Series
-F43
3 2
1: TXD
2: RXD
A1 A2 3: not used
Switch output 1 Switch output 2 LED-window
"Power on"/Disturbance 4: GND
Series
-F54
Note on communication with the UC-30GM-R2 interface cable
The UC-30GM-R2 interface cable allows for communication with the ultrasonic sensor using the ULTRA 2001 service program.
The cable creates a connection between the PC-internal RS 232 interface and the plug-in connection for the temperature/pro-
gram plug on the sensor. When setting up the connection on the sensor, make certain the plug is lined up correctly; otherwise
no communication will be possible. The protrusion of the round plug must be inserted into the groove of the plug connection
Series
-F64
on the sensor side and not into the arrow symbol on the sensor.
Adjustable parameter with service program ULTRA 2001
• Switching point 1 and 2
Series
• NO/NC function
-D1
• Mode of operation
• Sonic speed
• Temperature offset (The inherent temperature-rise of the sensor can be considered in the temperature compensation)
Series
LUC
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 95
Series -30GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
The remote potentiometer simplifies the adjustment of the distance range if the sensors are installed in an inaccessible location.
A 10 kΩ/0.3 W potentiometer serves as the remote potentiometer. The connection is realised using the plug connector pins 2
and 4 of the emitter (see: Electrical Connection).
The following distance ranges can be set using the remote potentiometer:
VariKont
Series
Adjustment of the internal distance regu- Distance range adjustable via remote potenti-
lator ometer
Minimum switching point 0 m ... 2 m
Maximum switching point 2 m ... 4 m
Series
When operating without a remote potentiometer, the plug connector pins 2 and 4 must be bridged.
-FP
Alignment
When adjusting the emitter and receiver, take care to align them as precisely as possible.
Angular tolerance: α < ± 2°
s < ± 5 mm
Series
maximum offset:
-F12
Synchronisation
-F43
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor wi ll
operate using an internally generated clock rate. The synchronisation of multiple sensors can be realised as follows:
External synchronisation:
The sensor can be synchronised by the external application of a square wave voltage. A synchronisation pulse at the synchro-
Series
-F54
nisation input starts a measuring cycle. The pulse must have a duration greater than 100 µs. The measuring cycle starts with
the falling edge of a synchronisation pulse. Two operating modes are available:
1. Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors are synchronised.
2. The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to individual sensors. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
Internal synchronisation:
Series
-F64
The synchronisation connections of up to 5 sensors capable of internal synchronisation are connected to one another. When
power is applied, these sensors will operate in multiplex mode.
The state of the switch output will not change until the switching threshold has been exceeded five times as an average of the
five measurements is determined internally. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal operation
of the sensor.
Series
-D1
Synchronisation cannot be performed during TEACH-IN and vice versa. The sensors must be operated in an unsynchronised
manner to teach the switching point.
A high level at the synchronisation input disables the sensor.
Note:
Series
LUC
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input has to be connected to ground (0V) or the sensor has to
be operated via a V1 cable connector (4-pin).
Adjusting the switching points
Double sheet
monitoring
The ultrasonic sensor features an analogue output with two teachable evaluation limits. These are set by applying the supply
voltage -U B or +UB to the TEACH-IN input. The supply voltage must be applied to the TEACH-IN input for at least 1 s. LEDs
indicate whether the sensor has recognised the target during the TEACH-IN procedure. Evaluation limit A1 is taught with -UB ,
A2 with +UB . For simple setting the switching point and the output functions the programming unit UB-PROG2 can be used.
Five different output functions can be set:
Power supplies
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
96 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -30GM Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
TEACH-IN window mode, normally-open function
• Set target to near switching point
-18GK/-18GM
Series
• TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -UB
• Set target to far switching point
• TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +UB
TEACH-IN window mode, normally-closed function
Series
-30GM
• Set target to near switching point
• TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +UB
• Set target to far switching point
VariKont
Series
• TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -UB
TEACH-IN one switching point, normally-open function
• Set target to near switching point
• TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +UB
Series
-FP
• Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
• TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -UB
TEACH-IN one switching point, normally-closed function
Series
-F12
• Set target to near switching point
• TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -UB
• Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
Series
• TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +UB
-F42
TEACH-IN detection of object presence
• Cover sensor with hand or remove all objects from sensing range
• TEACH-IN switching point A1 with -UB
Series
-F43
• TEACH-IN switching point A2 with +UB
Default setting
A1: unusable area
A2: nominal sensing range
Series
-F54
LED Displays
Displays in dependence on operating Green LED Red LED Yellow LED
mode
Series
TEACH-IN switching point
-F64
Object detected flashes off flashes
No object detected off flashes flashes
Object uncertain (TEACH-IN invalid) off flashes off
Normal operation on off switching state
Series
-D1
Interference off flashes previous state
LED-Window
Series
Dual-LED LED
LUC
green/red yellow
Double sheet
monitoring
Switch output
"Power on"/Disturbance
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on: 0 9/13/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 97
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
98 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series VariKont ®
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Model number Description Detection range Page
Series
-F43
UC500+U9+E6+R2 Switching output + RS 232-interface 500 mm 100
UC500+U9+IUE2+R2 Analogue output + RS 232-interface
UC3000+U9+E6+R2 Switching output + RS 232-interface 3000 mm 102
Series
-F54
UC3000+U9+E7+R2
UC3000+U9+IUE0+R2 Analogue output + 1 Switching output +
UC3000+U9+IUE2+R2 RS 232-interface
UJ3000+U1+8B+RS 8 Bit parallel-interface 3000 mm 104
Series
-F64
UBE6000+U1+SA2 Through beam ultrasonic barrier 6000 mm 106
UB500+U9+H3 for exter nal control/evaluation units 500 mm 108
UB3000+U9+H3 3000 mm
Series
-D1
For detailed function description, see page 110
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 99
Ultrasonic sensor UC500+U9+...+R2
-12GM
Series
• Serial interface
• Synchronisation options
-18GK/-18GM
• Temperature compensation
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC500+U9+ IUE2+R2
UC500+U9+ E6+ R2
Model number
Series
-F42
LED red/green permanently green : "Power on", flashes during standby operation ! !
red flashing : "Error", (e. g. background noise level too high)
Operating voltage 20 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS ! !
No-load supply current ≤ 60 mA ! !
Output type 1 switch output E5: pnp NO/NC switchable !
Series
Temperature influence ! !
LUC
Housing PBT ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam ! !
Mass 180 g ! !
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
100 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC500+U9+...+R2
-12GM
Series
30
M20 x 1.5
ø 5.3
-18GK/-18GM
Series
60
Series
-30GM
LED
VariKont
Series
X-axis 90˚
53 +0.3
59
Series
-FP
40
Y-axis 90˚
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 1
-F43
+ UB + UB
5 5
Sync. Input Sync. Input
U 2 U 2
Output 1, TD E2 Output, TD
4 4
Output 2, RD IU Output, RD
3 - UB 3 - UB
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Angle [degrees]
monitoring
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
10
0.0 0
2 1
UB500+ U9+ E6+R2 UC500+U9+IUE2+R2
0.1
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-10
0.2
-20
0.3
0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 101
Ultrasonic sensor UC3000+U9+...+R2
-12GM
Series
• Serial interface
• Synchronisation options
-18GK/-18GM
• Temperature compensation
Series
UC3000+U9+IUE2+R2
• 2 independent switch outputs
UC3000+U9+E6+R2
UC3000+U9+E7+R2
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC3000+U9+ IUE0+R2
UC3000+U9+ IUE2+R2
UC3000+U9+ E6+ R2
UC3000+U9+ E7+ R2
Model number
Series
-F42
LED red/green permanently green : "Power on", flashes during standby operation ! ! ! !
red flashing : "Error", (e. g. background noise level too high)
Operating voltage 20 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS ! ! ! !
No-load supply current ≤ 60 mA ! ! ! !
Output type 1 switch output E0, npn, normally open/closed switchable !
Series
-F64
Range hysteresis ! ! ! !
monitoring
Temperature influence ≤2 % ! ! ! !
Synchronisation 1 synchronous connection, bidirectional ! ! ! !
0-level: -UB ... (-UB + 1 V), 1-level: (-UB + 5 V) ... +UB
Pulse length ≥ 100 µs ! ! ! !
Pause length ≥ 2 ms ! ! ! !
Synchronisation frequency ≤ 20 Hz , with external synchronisation ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! ! !
Protection degree IP65 ! ! ! !
Connection terminal compartment, ≤ 2.5 mm2 conductor csa ! ! ! !
Accessories
Material
Housing PBT ! ! ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam ! ! ! !
Mass 180 g ! ! ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
102 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC3000+U9+...+R2
-12GM
Series
30
M20 x 1.5
ø 5.3
-18GK/-18GM
Series
60
Series
-30GM
LED
VariKont
Series
X-axis 90˚
53 +0.3
59
Series
-FP
40
Y-axis 90˚
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 1
-F43
+ UB + UB
5 2
Sync. Input Output 1,TD
U 2 U 4
Output 1, TD Output 2, RD
4 5
Output 2, RD Sync. Input
3 - UB 3 - UB
Series
-F54
Standard symbol/Connection: Standard symbol/Connection:
(Version IUE0, npn) (Version IUE2, pnp)
Series
1 1
-F64
+ UB + UB
5 5
Sync. Input Sync. Input
U 2 U 2
E0 Output, TD E2 Output, TD
4 4
IU Output, RD IU Output, RD
3 - UB 3 - UB
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
10
Switch status A1 Switch status A2 Switch output
1 "Power on"/Disturbance "Power on"/Disturbance
Power supplies
2
Control units/
0.0 0
output versions +E6 and +E7 output versions +IUE0 and +IUE2
0.5
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-10
1.0
1.5 -20
2.0
2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 103
Ultrasonic sensor UJ3000+U1+8B+RS
-12GM
Series
• 8 bit output
• Absolute polarity reversal protection
-18GK/-18GM
• Test input
Series
• Fault output
• Serial interface
• Parameterisable with ULTRA 2001
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UJ3000+ U1+8B+RS
Model number
Series
-F42
dynamic; ≤ 100 ms
LED red/green green LED: Power on !
red LED, flashing at 2 Hz: error (high level of external noise)
Operating voltage 20 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS !
No-load supply current ≤ 90 mA !
Series
-F54
Housing PBT !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam !
Mass 290 g !
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
104 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UJ3000+U1+8B+RS
-12GM
Series
30
ø 5.3
-18GK/-18GM
Series
60
Series
-30GM
LED
VariKont
Series
X-axis 90˚
53 +0.3
59
Series
-FP
40
Y-axis 90˚
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
-F43
+UB
8 bit output
U Error output
-UB
Test input
Transmit-Data
Series
Receiver-Data
-F54
Legend:
+UB = Brown Test input = Grey/Pink
-UB = Blue Error output = Red/Blue
Interface:
Receiver-Data RD = White/Green
Series
-F64
Transmit-Data TD = Brown/Green
8 bit output:
A1 = White A2 = Yellow
A3 = Pink A4 = Red
A5 = Green A6 = Grey
Series
A7 = Black A8 = Violet
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
10
"Power on"/Error
1
Power supplies
2
Control units/
0.0 0
0.5
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-10
1.0
1.5 -20
2.0
2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 105
Through-beam ultrasonic barrier UBE6000+U1+SA2
-12GM
Series
• Adjustable sensitivity
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UBE6000+U1+SA2
Model number
Series
-F42
Receiver: ≤ 1 W
-F54
Output type Receiver: Complementary output stage 200 mA, Short-circuit/overload protected !
Voltage drop Receiver: UB - 3 V !
Switching frequency ≤ 30 Hz !
Standards EN 60947-5-2 !
Series
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
106 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UBE6000+U1+SA2
-12GM
Series
30
M20 x 1.5
ø 5.3
-18GK/-18GM
Series
60
Series
-30GM
Oblong hole 5.3 x 7.3
131
LED
VariKont
Series
X-axis 90˚
53 +0.3
59
potentiometer
Series
-FP
40
Y-axis 90˚
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol / Connection: Standard symbol / Connection:
Emitter Transceiver
Series
-F43
1 1
+ UB + UB
U U 2 Switch output
4 alternative
2
- UB 3 - UB
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
red
monitoring
LED
yellow
Signal too strong strong weak too weak
"Power on"
Interference Working range poor
Power supplies
Control units/
0.0
2.0
Potentiometer setting LED-Window-Receiver
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
4.0
5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 107
Ultrasonic sensor UB...+U9+H3
-12GM
Series
• Separate evaluation
• With temperature sensor
-18GK/-18GM
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB3000+U9+ H3
UB500+U9+ H3
Model number
60 ... 500 mm !
Unusable area !
0 ... 300 mm 1)
1) !
0 ... 60 mm
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm ! !
Transducer frequency approx. 130 kHz !
Series
-F43
The sensing range is determined in the downstream evaluation electronics (e. g. the units UH3-KHD2-4E5, or UH3-KHD2-4I).
The sensing range is determined on the basis of the echo time of a transmitted pulse in pulse-echo mode.
Temperature comp ensation
A temperature pulse is available at the temperature output for external temperature compensation. It is synchronous to the externally applied clock pulse and has
the length T Tem p , calculated as follows:
Power supplies
Control units/
TTe mp [µ s ] = T T akt[ µ s] + T [K ] × 10 µ s ⁄ K
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Put into the formula the temperature in Kelvin and the clock time in the unit µs.
1)
The unusable area (blind range) BR depends on the pulse duration.
Accessories
The unusable area reaches a minimum with the shortest pulse duration.
2)
The sensors detection range depends on the pulse duration.
With pulse duration < typical pulse duration, the sensors detection range may be reduced.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
108 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB...+U9+H3
-12GM
Series
30
M20 x 1.5
ø 5.3
-18GK/-18GM
Series
60
Series
-30GM
Oblong hole 5.3 x 7.3
131
VariKont
Series
X-axis 90˚
53 +0.3
59
Series
-FP
40
Y-axis 90˚
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
-F43
1
+ UB
5
U Temp. output
2
Clock
4
Echo
3
- UB
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Angle [degrees]
monitoring
90 80 70 60 50 40 30 90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
20 Temp.-
impulse
TImp
10
10
TImp = T [K] x 10 µs/K
1 TTemp = TClock + TImp
Power supplies
2
Control units/
0.0 0 0.0 0
2 1
0.5
0.1
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-10 -10
1.0
0.2
1.5 -20
-20
0.3 2.0
0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5
Distance [m] Distance [m]
Accessories
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm Curve 1: flat plate 100 mm x 100 mm
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
UB500+... UB3000+...
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 109
Series VariKont ® Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UC500+U9+E6+R2
-18GK/-18GM
Series
For further information on the sensor's command set, please see the publication "Command Set for Ultrasonic Sensors with
RS 232 Interface".
Caution: Ensure that DIP switch S10 is correctly set before connecting the RS 232 interface.
Synchronisation
VariKont
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor wi ll
Series
operate using an internally generated clock rate. It can be synchronised by applying a square wave voltage. A falling edge leads
to the transmission of a single ultrasonic pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal
operation of the sensor. A high level > 1 s will result in the standby operation of the sensor (green LED).
Several functions are available:
Series
• Two to five sensors can be synchronised by interconnecting their synchronisation inputs. In this case, the sensors alternately
-FP
The response time increases when sensors are synchronised as the measuring cycle time is increased by the synchronisation.
Adjustment of the evaluation window via coding switch in terminal compartment
ON
-F43
RS 232-
-F54
1 ^ ON, 0 ^ OFF
-D1
UC500+U9+IUE2+R2
Series
The outputs of the sensor can be used in two different operating modes: Switching/analogue mode, or RS 232 mode (RS 232,
9600, n, 8, 1). Select the operating mode with DIP switch 10. The limits of the IU ramp are set with the DIP switches 1-4 and
5-8 (see table). Switch 9 is used to set the close or open function of the switch output.
Double sheet
monitoring
For further information on the sensor's command set, please see the publication "Command Set for Ultrasonic Sensors with
RS 232 Interface".
Caution: Ensure that DIP switch S10 is correctly set before connecting the RS 232 interface.
Synchronisation
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor wi ll
Power supplies
Control units/
operate using an internally generated clock rate. It can be synchronised by applying a square wave voltage. A falling edge leads
to the transmission of a single ultrasonic pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal
operation of the sensor. A high level > 1 s will result in the standby operation of the sensor (green LED).
Several functions are available:
Date of edi ti on 0 8/17/20 05
• Two to five sensors can be synchronised by interconnecting their synchronisation inputs. In this case, the sensors alternately
transmit ultrasonic pulses.
Accessories
• Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors are synchronised.
• The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to individual sensors. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
The response time increases when sensors are synchronised as the measuring cycle time is increased by the synchronisation.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
110 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series VariKont ® Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Adjustment of the evaluation window via coding switch in terminal compartment
-18GK/-18GM
Switch NDE Switch FDE DIP Switches in Terminal Compartment:
Series
12 34 [mm] 56 78 [mm] Adjustment of the Target Window
00 00 60 00 00 60 Switch/
N.O. IU-mode
00 01 80 00 01 80
00 10 100 00 10 100 ON
Series
-30GM
00 11 125 00 11 125
01 00 150 01 00 150
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
01 01 175 01 01 175
01 10 200 01 10 200 Near span Far span
RS 232-
VariKont
boundary boundary
Series
01 11 230 01 11 230 mode
10 00 260 10 00 260 N.C.
10 01 290 10 01 290 near span boundary < distant limit ⇒ IU-rising slope
near span boundary > distant limit ⇒ IU-declining slope
10 10 325 10 10 325 near span boundary = distant limit ⇒ IU-switch point
10 11 360 10 11 360
Series
Switch point switch output:
-FP
11 00 395 11 00 395 (NDE + FDE)/2 (Preconfiguration)
11 01 430 11 01 430
11 10 465 11 10 465
11 11 500 11 11 500
Series
-F12
1 ^ ON, 0 ^ OFF
Series
-F42
Description of the sensor functions
The outputs of the sensor can be used in two different operating modes: Switching mode with 2 adjustable switching points, or
RS 232 mode (RS 232, 9600, n, 8, 1). Select the operating mode with DIP switch 10. The switching points are set with the DIP
switches 1-4 and 5-8 (see table). Switch 9 is used to set the close or open function of the switch outputs.
For further information on the sensor's command set, please see the publication "Command Set for Ultrasonic Sensors with
Series
-F43
RS 232 Interface".
Caution: Ensure that DIP switch S10 is correctly set before connecting the RS 232 interface.
Synchronisation
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor will
Series
-F54
operate using an internally generated clock rate. It can be synchronised by applying a square wave voltage. A falling edge leads
to the transmission of a single ultrasonic pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal
operation of the sensor. A high level > 1 s will result in the standby operation of the sensor (green LED).
Several functions are available:
• Two to five sensors can be synchronised by interconnecting their synchronisation inputs. In this case, the sensors alternately
Series
-F64
transmit ultrasonic pulses.
• Multiple sensors can be controlled by the same synchronisation signal. The sensors are synchronised.
• The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to individual sensors. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
The response time increases when sensors are synchronised as the measuring cycle time is increased by the synchronisation.
Series
-D1
Adjustment of the evaluation window via coding switch in terminal compartment
00 11 750 00 11 850
01 00 900 01 00 100 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
01 01 1050 01 01 1150
01 10 1200 01 10 1300 Switch distance Switch distance
RS 232-
Switch output 1 Switch output 2
01 11 1350 01 11 1450 mode
Power supplies
Control units/
11 00 2300 11 00 2400
11 01 2500 11 01 2600
Accessories
11 10 2700 11 10 2800
11 11 2900 11 11 3000
1 ^ ON, 0 ^ OFF
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 111
Series VariKont ® Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
RS 232 Interface".
Caution: Ensure that DIP switch S10 is correctly set before connecting the RS 232 interface.
Synchronisation
VariKont
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor wi ll
Series
operate using an internally generated clock rate. It can be synchronised by applying a square wave voltage. A falling edge leads
to the transmission of a single ultrasonic pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal
operation of the sensor. A high level > 1 s will result in the standby operation of the sensor (green LED).
Several functions are available:
Series
• Two to five sensors can be synchronised by interconnecting their synchronisation inputs. In this case, the sensors alternately
-FP
The response time increases when sensors are synchronised as the measuring cycle time is increased by the synchronisation.
Adjustment of the evaluation window via coding switch in terminal compartment
1 ^ ON, 0 ^ OFF
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
112 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series VariKont ® Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UJ3000+U1+8B+RS
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Description of the sensor functions
The measurement of the distance is realised using the echo time of the ultrasonic pulse. The µ processor calculates the di-
stance on the basis of the echo time and the speed of sound. The distance is directly issued in parallel in the form of an 8-bit
data word.
Series
-30GM
A serial interface (RS 232, 9 600, n, 8, 1) is also available.
The output functions can be set up flexibly. For further information on the sensor's command set, please see the publication
"Command Set for Ultrasonic Sensors with RS 232 interface".
In the event of interference that the sensor cannot handle, the sensor goes into failure mode in that the failure output opens
and the 8-bit output retains the most recent measuring value. The dual LED goes into the red flashing state.
VariKont
Series
A 1 level at the test input causes the 8-bit output to switch from 00000000 to 11111111 and back every 200 ms.
UBE6000+U1+SA2
Series
Description of the sensor function
-FP
This system consists of one emitter an one receiver, which are operating independend of each other.
For the handling of the wide dynamic range the sensitivity of the receiver can be adjusted by means of a built in potentiometer.
The red LED can be used as adjustment aid.
Series
-F12
System adjustment
Mount emitter and receiver in the desired distance. The detection area has to be unobstructed. Switch on supply voltage and
turn potentiometer counter-clockwise until the red LED lights up permanently (strong signal). In case of short distance applica-
tion, it may happen, that the red LED flashes at a frequency of approx. 2 Hz caused by multi sound reflections between the
Series
sensors transducers. In that case, turn the potentiometer clockwise, until the red LED goes off.
-F42
Make sure, that the receivers output is not activated (yellow LED off) when the detection area is unobstructed.
In the strong working range, the system is highly resistant against any interference. Only large objects can be detected.
In the weak working range the systems resistance against interference is decreased, but the system is highly sensitve even to
detect small objects.
Series
-F43
UB...+U9+H3
Series
-F54
The sensing range is determined in the downstream evaluation electronics (e. g. the units UH3-KHD2-4E5, or UH3-KHD2-4I).
The sensing range is determined on the basis of the echo time of a transmitted pulse in pulse-echo mode.
Temperature compensation
A temperature pulse is available at the temperature output for external temperature compensation. It is synchronous to the
Series
-F64
externally applied clock pulse and has the length T T emp, calculated as follows:
TTe mp [ µs ] = TT akt [µ s ] + T[ K ] × 10 µ s ⁄ K
Series
Put into the formula the temperature in Kelvin and the clock time in the unit µs.
-D1
1)
The unusable area (blind range) BR depends on the pulse duration.
The unusable area reaches a minimum with the shortest pulse duration.
2)
Series
With pulse duration < typical pulse duration, the sensors detection range may be reduced.
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 113
Series -FP Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
114 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -FP
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
Model number Description Detection range Page
-F43
UC6000-FP-E6-R2-P5 2 switching outputs + RS 232 interface 6000 mm 116
UC6000-FP-E7-R2-P5
UC6000-FP-IUE0-R2-P5 1 analogue output + 1 switching output + 6000 mm 116
Series
-F54
UC6000-FP-IUE2-R2-P5 RS 232 interface
UJ4000-FP-E2-P1 1 switching output 4000 mm 118
UJ6000-FP-8B-RS 8 bit parallel interface + RS 232 interface 4000 mm 120
Series
-F64
UB1000+FP1+E6 Reflex sensor with switching output 1000 mm 122
UB6000-FP-H3 For external control/evaluation unit 6000 mm 124
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 115
Ultrasonic sensor UC6000-FP-...-R2-P5
-12GM
Series
• Serial interface
• Synchronisation options
-18GK/-18GM
• Temperature compensation
Series
UC6000-FP-IUE2-R2-P5
• 2 independent switch outputs
UC6000-FP-E6-R2-P5
UC6000-FP-E7-R2-P5
VariKont
Series
• UC6000-FP-E7-R2-P5
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC6000-FP-IUE0-R2-P5
UC6000-FP-IUE2-R2-P5
UC6000-FP-E6-R2 -P5
UC6000-FP-E7-R2 -P5
Model number
Series
-F42
RL ≤ 500 Ohm: current output 4 ... 20 mA, RL ≥ 1 kOhm: voltage output 2 ... 10 V
-D1
≥ 2 ms
Control units/
Pause length ! ! ! !
Synchronisation frequency ≤ 10 Hz , with external synchronisation ! ! ! !
Interface type RS 232, 9600 bit/s, no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
RS 232, 9600 bit/s, no parity, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit (S10 = OFF) ! !
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! ! !
Protection degree IP65 ! ! ! !
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
116 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC6000-FP-...-R2-P5
-12GM
Series
ø73
-18GK/-18GM
21
Series
40
7
Series
-30GM
LED
M20x1.5
ø5.3
VariKont
Series
80
65
Series
-FP
65
Series
-F12
80
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 1
-F43
+ UB + UB
5 2
Sync. Input Output 1,TD
U 2 U 4
Output 1, TD Output 2, RD
4 5
Output 2, RD Sync. Input
3 - UB 3 - UB
Series
-F54
Standard symbol/Connection: Standard symbol/Connection:
(Version IUE0, npn) (Version IUE2, pnp)
Series
1 1
-F64
+ UB + UB
5 5
Sync. Input Sync. Input
U 2 U 2
E0 Output, TD E2 Output, TD
4 4
IU Output, RD IU Output, RD
3 - UB 3 - UB
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Angle [degrees]
monitoring
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
10
0.0 2 1 0
1.0
output versions -E6 and -E7 output versions -IUE0 and -IUE2
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
2.0 -10
3.0
-20
4.0
5.0 6.0 7.0 8.0 9.0 10.0
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 117
Ultrasonic sensor UJ4000-FP-E2-P1
-12GM
Series
• TEACH-IN input
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
´
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UJ4000-F P-E2-P1
Model number
Series
Standards EN 60947-5-2 !
-F64
Housing PBT !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam !
Mass 320 g !
Series
The measurement of the distance is realised using the echo time of ultrasonic
pulses. After installation, the transmitter is taught with the distance to a station-
Sensor
ary reflector and stores this value by shorting the TEACH-IN input with -U B or
Double sheet
monitoring
flector must also be reduced in size accordingly. This may result in a reduction SR
of range.
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Unobstructed
Accessories
region ± 6 %
Standard
reflector
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
118 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UJ4000-FP-E2-P1
-12GM
Series
ø73
-18GK/-18GM
21
Series
40
7
Series
-30GM
LED
M20x1.5
ø5.3
VariKont
Series
Series
80
-FP
65
Series
-F12
65
80
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
-F43
1 + UB
2
U Teach input
4 Switch output
3 - UB
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
10
Switch output
"Power on"/Disturbance
Power supplies
Control units/
0.0 0
2 1
0.5
1.0
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-10
1.5
2.0 -20
2.5
3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 119
Ultrasonic sensor UJ6000-FP-8B+RS
-12GM
Series
• 8 bit output
• Absolute polarity reversal protection
-18GK/-18GM
• Test input
Series
• Fault output
• Serial interface
• Parameterisable with ULTRA 2001
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UJ6000-F P-8B+RS
Model number
Series
-F42
dynamic; ≤ 270 ms
LED red/green green LED: Power on !
red LED, flashing at 2 Hz: error (high level of external noise)
Operating voltage 20 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS !
No-load supply current ≤ 90 mA !
Series
Material
Housing PBT !
Series
LUC
The meas urement of the distance is realised using the echo time of the ultras onic pulse. The µ proc es sor calculates the distance on
the bas is of the ec ho time and the speed of sound. The distance is directly iss ued in parallel in the form of an 8-bit data word.
A serial interface (RS 232, 9 600, n, 8, 1) is also av ailable.
The output functions can be set up flexibly . For further information on the sens or's command set, please see the publication "Com-
Power supplies
In the ev ent of interferenc e that the sensor cannot handle, the s ensor goes into failure mode in that the failure output opens and the
8-bit output retains the most recent m easuring v alue. The dual LED goes into the red flashing state.
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
A 1 lev el at the tes t input causes the 8-bit output to switch from 00000000 to 11111111 and back every 200 ms.
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
120 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UJ6000-FP-8B+RS
-12GM
Series
ø73
-18GK/-18GM
21
Series
40
7
Series
-30GM
LED
approx. 33
VariKont
ø5.3
Series
Series
-FP
80
65
Series
-F12
65
80
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
-F43
+UB
8 bit output
U Error output
-UB
Test input
Transmit-Data
Series
Receiver-Data
-F54
Legend:
+UB = Brown Test input = Grey/Pink
-UB = Blue Error output = Red/Blue
Interface:
Receiver-Data RD = White/Green
Series
-F64
Transmit-Data TD = Brown/Green
8 bit output:
A1 = White A2 = Yellow
A3 = Pink A4 = Red
A5 = Green A6 = Grey
Series
A7 = Black A8 = Violet
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
10
"Power on"/Disturbance
Power supplies
Control units/
0.0 2 1 0
0.5
1.0
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-10
1.5
2.0
2.5 -20
3.0
3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 121
Reflex sensor UB1000+FP1+E6
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB1000+F P1 +E6
Model number
Series
Voltage drop !
-F64
Housing PBT !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam !
Mass 338 g !
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
122 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB1000+FP1+E6
-12GM
Series
ø73
-18GK/-18GM
21
Series
40
7
Series
-30GM
LED
Pg13.5
ø5.3
VariKont
Series
Series
80
-FP
65
Series
-F12
65
80
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
-F43
1 + UB
2
U Switch output 1
4 Switch output 2
3 - UB
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Switching
Switching
Detection
Angle [degrees]
monitoring
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
point
point
limit
20
S9 S10
10
A1 1 0
Switch status 2 Switch status 1
A2 1 0 "Power on"/Disturbance
Power supplies
Control units/
0.0
2
0 A1 0 0
1
A2 0 0
A1 1 1
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
0.5 -10
A2 1 1
1.0 -20 A1 0 1
A2 0 1
1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0
Distance [m]
Blind range (forbidden)
Accessories
Output open
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm Output closed
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 123
Ultrasonic sensor UB6000-FP-H3
-12GM
Series
• Separate evaluation
• With temperature sensor
-18GK/-18GM
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB6000-FP-H3
Model number
Input type 1 pulse input for transmitter pulse, activation through open collector npn !
< 1 V: emitter active, > 4 V: emitter inactive
Pulse length 50 ... 700 µs (typ. 500 µs) 2) !
Pause length ≥ 50 x pulse length !
Standards EN 60947-5-2 !
Series
The sens ing range is determined in the dow ns tream ev aluation electronics (e. g. the units UH3-KH D2-4E5, or UH3-KHD2-4I).
The sens ing range is determined on the bas is of the ec ho time of a transmitted pulse in pulse-ec ho m ode.
Temperatur e co mpensation
Double sheet
A temperature pulse is av ailable at the temperature output for external temperature compensation. It is synchronous to the externally
monitoring
applied cloc k pulse and has the length T T em p, c alc ulated as follows:
TTe mp [µ s ] = T T akt[ µ s] + T [K ] × 10 µ s ⁄ K
Power supplies
Control units/
Put into the formula the temperature in Kelv in and the c lock time in the unit µs .
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
1) The unus able area (blind range) BR depends on the pulse duration.
The unus able area reaches a minimum with the s hortest puls e duration.
2) The sensors detection range depends on the puls e duration.
Accessories
With pulse duration < typical puls e duration, the s ensors detection range may be reduced.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
124 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB6000-FP-H3
-12GM
Series
ø73
-18GK/-18GM
21
Series
40
7
Series
-30GM
LED
M20x1.5
ø5.3
VariKont
Series
80
65
Series
-FP
65
Series
-F12
80
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
-F43
1
+ UB
5
U Temp. output
2
Clock
4
Echo
3
- UB
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20
Temp.-
impulse
TImp
10
0.0 2 1 0
0.5
1.0
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-10
1.5
2.0
2.5 -20
3.0
3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5
Distance [m]
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 125
Series -FP Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
For further information on the sensor's command set, please see the publication "Command Set for Ultrasonic Sensors with
RS 232 Interface".
Caution: Ensure that DIP switch S10 is correctly set before connecting the RS 232 interface.
Synchronisation
VariKont
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor wi ll
Series
operate using an internally generated clock rate. It can be synchronised by applying a square wave voltage. A falling edge leads
to the transmission of a single ultrasonic pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal
operation of the sensor. A high level > 1 s will result in the standby operation of the sensor (green LED).
Several functions are available:
Series
• Two to five sensors can be synchronised by interconnecting their synchronisation inputs. In this case, the sensors alternately
-FP
The response time increases when sensors are synchronised as the measuring cycle time is increased by the synchronisation.
Adjustment of the evaluation window via coding switch in terminal compartment
00 1 1 1700 00 1 1 1850
01 0 0 2000 01 0 0 2150
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
01 0 1 2300 01 0 1 2450
01 1 0 2600 01 1 0 2750
Switch distance Switch distance
01 1 1 2900 01 1 1 3050 RS 232-
Series
mode
10 0 0 3200 10 0 0 3350
10 0 1 3500 10 0 1 3650 N.C.
10 1 0 3800 10 1 0 4000
10 1 1 4200 10 1 1 4400
Series
-F64
11 0 0 4600 11 0 0 4800
11 0 1 5000 11 0 1 5200
11 1 0 5400 11 1 0 5600
11 1 1 5800 11 1 1 6000
1 ^ ON, 0 ^ OFF
Series
-D1
The outputs of the sensor can be used in two different operating modes: Switching/analogue mode, or RS 232 mode (RS 232,
LUC
9600, n, 8, 1). Select the operating mode with DIP switch 10. The limits of the IU ramp are set with the DIP switches 1-4 and
5-8 (see table). Switch 9 is used to set the close or open function of the switch output.
For further information on the sensor's command set, please see the publication "Command Set for Ultrasonic Sensors with
Double sheet
monitoring
RS 232 Interface".
Caution: Ensure that DIP switch S10 is correctly set before connecting the RS 232 interface.
Synchronisation
The sensor features a synchronisation input for the suppression of mutual interference. If this input is not used, the sensor wi ll
operate using an internally generated clock rate. It can be synchronised by applying a square wave voltage. A falling edge leads
Power supplies
Control units/
to the transmission of a single ultrasonic pulse. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input will result in the normal
operation of the sensor. A high level > 1 s will result in the standby operation of the sensor (green LED).
Several functions are available:
• Two to five sensors can be synchronised by interconnecting their synchronisation inputs. In this case, the sensors alternately
Date of edi ti on 0 8/17/20 05
• The synchronisation pulses are sent cyclically to individual sensors. The sensors operate in multiplex mode.
The response time increases when sensors are synchronised as the measuring cycle time is increased by the synchronisation.
Adjustment of the evaluation window via coding switch in terminal compartment
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
126 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -FP Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Switch NDE Switch FDE DIP Switches in Terminal Compartment:
-18GK/-18GM
1 23 4 [mm] 5 67 8 [mm] Adjustment of the Target Window
Series
0 00 0 800 0 00 0 800 Switch/
0 00 1 1100 0 00 1 1100 N.O. IU-mode
0 01 0 1400 0 01 0 1400
0 01 1 1700 0 01 1 1700 ON
0 10 0 2000 0 10 0 2000
Series
-30GM
0 10 1 2300 0 10 1 2300 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
0 11 0 2650 0 11 0 2650
0 11 1 3000 0 11 1 3000 Near span Far span
RS 232-
1 00 0 3350 1 00 0 3350 boundary boundary
mode
VariKont
Series
1 00 1 3700 1 00 1 3700
N.C.
1 01 0 4050 1 01 0 4050
near span boundary < distant limit ⇒ IU-rising slope
1 01 1 4400 1 01 1 4400 near span boundary > distant limit ⇒ IU-declining slope
near span boundary = distant limit ⇒ IU-switch point
1 10 0 4800 1 10 0 4800
1 10 1 5200 1 10 1 5200 Switch point switch output:
Series
(NDE + FDE)/2 (Preconfiguration)
-FP
1 11 0 5600 1 11 0 5600
1 11 1 6000 1 11 1 6000
1 ^ ON, 0 ^ OFF
UB1000+FP1+E6
Series
-F12
Description of the sensor functions
The sensor is suitable for direct-detection mode as well as beam-interruption mode. The functions of the outputs can be set
with switches S9 and S10 in accordance with the following table.
Series
-F42
DIP Switches in Terminal Compartment
Switch Switching range
S1 200 ... 300 mm Window-/beam
N.O. interruption operation
S2 300 ... 400 mm
Series
S3 400 ... 500 mm
-F43
ON
S4 500 ... 600 mm
S5 600 ... 700 mm
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
S6 700 ... 800 mm
Series
S7 800 ... 900 mm
-F54
Switching range
Independent
S8 900 ... 1000 mm setting
switch points
A continuous switching range must be selected. When operating with independent N.C.
switching points, A1 switches the upper limit and A2 the lower limit of the switching
range.
Series
-F64
Barrier mode
In barrier mode, primarily the range up to objects used as reflector will be evaluated (e. g. machine part). Objects entering the
range between the sensor and reflector are detected. This includes objects of a strongly sound-absorbent nature and objects
positioned at an angle to the sensor's active axis. In this case, no echo reaches the receiver. If the sound is reflected by an
Series
-D1
object, the reflection will have a different echo time from the regular reflector echo. The sensor detects the object on the basis
of the shorter echo time or lack of an echo while in barrier mode.
Sensor Scanning Reflector
range
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Object
Power supplies
Control units/
For use as a barrier, set the close function (S9 = 1) and window mode (barrier mode) (S10 = 1). The distance between the
sensor and the reflector determines the switching range which must be set using a switch between S1 and S8. Only one switch
may be set to "ON", resulting in a switching range of 100 mm.
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
The sensor and/or reflector should be adjusted in such a manner that output A1 is closed. The reflector should be positioned
as closely as possible to the sensor's near switching range limit. The sensor works in direct-detection mode in the area between
Accessories
the reflector and the sensor's near limit. A reliable evaluation is therefore not possible.
If an interruption of the barrier by an object is determined during operation, switch output A1 is opened. Output A2 is not taken
into consideration as a rule, as it also works in direct-detection mode rather than beam-interruption mode.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 127
Series -F12 Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
128 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F12
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
Model number Detection range Page
-F43
UB800-F12P-EP-V15 800 mm 130
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 129
Ultrasonic sensor UB800-F12P-EP-V15
-12GM
Series
• Push-pull output
• Selectable sound lobe width
-18GK/-18GM
• Synchronisation options
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Very small unusable area
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
U
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB800-F12P-EP-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
IND.CONTR.EQ 57M3
Standards EN 60947-5-2 !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) !
Power supplies
Control units/
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; foam polyurethane, cover PBT !
Mass 60 g !
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
130 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB800-F12P-EP-V15
-12GM
Series
M4 / 4 deep 10
-18GK/-18GM
15
Series
7.5
41.5
5
Series
-30GM
49
32.5
65
ø4.5
5.3
VariKont
2
Series
5.5
7
M12x1
Series
19.5
-FP
Connector 90˚ adjustable position
24
11.5
2 1 Operating display green
Series
-F12
3 Turnover switch Q / Q
4 Switching point adjuster
1 4
3 5 Acoustic axis transducer
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connections:
(version EP, pnp/npn)
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB
2 (WH) Beam input
U 5 (GY)
Synchronous
4 (BK)
Switch output
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
200
flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
150 object distance
100
2. normally closed function Q
50
Power supplies
0
Control units/
-50
-100
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-150
round bar, Ø 25 mm
-200
0 200 400 600 800 1000 1200
Distance X [mm]
Accessories
Y
wide sound lobe
X
narrow sound lobe
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 131
Series -F12 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UB800-F12P-EP-V15
-18GK/-18GM
Synchronisation
Series
To suppress mutual influence, the sensor is equipped with a synchronisation connection. If this is not activated, the sensor
works with an internally generated clock. Synchronisation of multiple sensors can be achieved in the following ways.
External synchronisation
The sensor can be synchronized by external application of a square wave voltage. A synchronisation impulse on the synchro-
Series
-30GM
nisation input leads to the execution of one measurement cycle. The impulse width must be larger than 100 µs. The measure-
ment cycle starts with the falling flank. A low level > 1 sec or an open synchronisation input puts the sensor in normal mode. A
high level on the synchronisation input deactivates the sensor.
Two operational modes are possible
1. Multiple sensors are controlled using the same synchronisation signal. The sensors work in synch.
VariKont
Series
2. The synchronisation impulses are cyclically fed to only one sensor at a time. The sensors work in multiplex mode.
Autosynchronisation
The synchronisation connections of up to 10 sensors are connected together with the option of autosynchronisation. These
sensors work in multiplex mode after power is switched on. The activation delay is increased corresponding to the numer of
synchronised sensors.
Series
-FP
Note:
If the synchronisation option is not used, the synchronisation input should be connected to ground (0V), or the sensor connec-
ted using a V1 connector cable (4-pin).
Selection of beam characteristics
Series
-F12
By switching the beam input, the activation characteristics of the ultrasound sensor can be selected. If the beam input is open
or connected to +UB , the sensor works with a wide ultrasonic cone. A beam input connected to -UB causes the sensor to work
with a narrower ultrasonic cone. This setting is preferred when an object in the vicinity of the sensor is close to the ultrasonic
beam, and should be suppressed. The characteristic of the ultrasonic cone can be changed during sensor operation. Switching
Series
the sound cone characteristics becomes active one second after the change to the signal level at the beam input.
-F42
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
132 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F42
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
UB...-F42-...V15 UB...-F42S-...V15
(top looker) (sde looker)
Series
-F12
Model number AC-version/ side looker top looker Detection range Page
Series
-F42
relay output
UB400-F42-UK-V95 ! ! 400 mm 134
UB400-F42S-UK-V95 ! !
Series
-F43
UB500-F42S-E4-V15 !
UB500-F42-E5-V15 !
UB500-F42S-E5-V15 !
UB500-F42-I-V15 !
Series
-F54
UB500-F42S-I-V15 !
UB500-F42-U-V15 !
UB500-F42S-U-V15 !
UB500-F42-E6-V15 !
Series
-F64
UB500-F42S-E6-V15 !
UB500-F42-E7-V15 !
UB500-F42S-E7-V15 !
Series
UB1500-F42S-UK-V95 ! !
-D1
UB2000-F42-E4-V15 ! 2000 mm 140
UB2000-F42S-E4-V15 !
UB2000-F42-E5-V15 !
!
Series
UB2000-F42S-E5-V15
LUC
UB2000-F42-I-V15 !
UB2000-F42S-I-V15 !
UB2000-F42-U-V15 !
Double sheet
monitoring
UB2000-F42S-U-V15 !
UB2000-F42-E6-V15 !
UB2000-F42S-E6-V15 !
UB2000-F42-E7-V15 !
Power supplies
!
Control units/
UB2000-F42S-E7-V15
UB3000-F42-UK-V95 ! ! 3000 mm 142
UB4000-F42-E4-V15 ! 4000 mm 144
UB4000-F42-E5-V15 !
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
UB4000-F42-I-V15 !
UB4000-F42-U-V15 !
Accessories
UB4000-F42-E6-V15 !
UB4000-F42-E7-V15 !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 133
Ultrasonic sensor UB400-F42(S)-UK-V95
-12GM
Series
• TEACH-IN
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB400-F42S-UK-V9 5
UB400-F42-UK-V95
Model number
Series
-F42
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
134 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB400-F42(S)-UK-V95
-12GM
Series
15 7.5 5.2 15 7.5 5.2
7/8"-16 UN 2A
7/8"-16 UN 2A
15.5
15.5
-18GK/-18GM
Membrane keys Membrane keys
10
Series
A2
A2
52.5
52.5
TEACH IN
TEACH IN
MODE
MODE
34
34
80
80
65
65
A1
A1
LED window LED window
5
16 16
Series
-30GM
10 65 10 65
34 80 34 80
10
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Housing version -F42 Housing version -F42S
Electrical connection
Series
-F12
Standard symbol/Connections:
1 AC/DC
U 5
20 V ... 253 V
4
Series
max. 250 V AC/120 V DC
-F42
2
Imax = 3 A
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Diagrams
Series
1. Switch point operation
-D1
Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20 normally open
A1 -> ∞
A2
10 normally closed
A2 -> ∞
Series
A1
LUC
2 1 0 2. Window operation
50
A1 < A2
monitoring
-10 A1 A2
150
normally closed
A2 < A1 A2 A1
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 135
Ultrasonic sensor UB500-F42(S)-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Synchronisation options
• 1 Switch output
UB500-F42(S)-E4-V15
Series
-30GM
UB500-F42(S)-E5-V15
• 2 independent switch outputs
UB500-F42(S)-E6-V15
UB500-F42(S)-E7-V15
VariKont
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB500-F42S-E4-V15
UB500-F42S-E5-V15
UB500-F42S-E6-V15
UB500-F42S-E7-V15
UB500-F42S-U-V1 5
UB500-F42-E4-V15
UB500-F42-E5-V15
UB500-F42-E6-V15
UB500-F42-E7-V15
UB500-F42S-I-V15
UB500-F42-U-V15
UB500-F42-I-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
LED yellow 2 permanent: switching state switch output 2, flashing: TEACH-IN function ! ! ! !
-F54
Housing ABS ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; foam polyurethane, cover PBT ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! !
Mass 140 g ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
136 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB500-F42(S)-...-V15
-12GM
Series
15 7.5 5.2 15 7.5 5.2
15.5
15.5
-18GK/-18GM
Membrane keys Membrane keys
10
M12x1
M12x1
Series
A2
A2
52.5
52.5
SET
TEACH IN
SET
TEACH IN
34
34
MODE
MODE
80
80
65
65
A1
A1
LED window LED window
5
16 16
Series
-30GM
10 65 10 65
34 80 34 80
10
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Housing version -F 42 H ousing version -F42S
Electrical connection
Series
-F12
Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections:
(version E4, npn) (version E6, pnp) (version I)
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 2 (WH)
Switch output Sync. Teaching input
U 2 (WH) U 4 (BK) U 5 (GY)
Teaching input Switch output 1 Sync.
Series
5 (GY) 2 (WH) 4 (BK)
-F42
Synchronous Switch output 2 Analog output
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F43
Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections:
(version E5, pnp) (version E7, npn) (version U)
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) 1 (BN)
+ UB + UB
2 (WH) Teaching input 4 (BK) 2 (WH)
Switch output 1 Teaching input
U 5 (GY) U 2 (WH) U 5 (GY)
Synchronous Switch output 2 Sync.
4 4 (BK)
Series
(BK) 5 (GY)
Switch output Sync. Analog output
-F54
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Diagrams output versions -I and -U output versions -E6 and E7 output versions -E4 and -E5
Series
Distance Y [m]
-D1
0.2
Flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
Object distance
Object distance
0.1 Object distance
N. O. (A1 < A2):
Rising ramp
Output 1 1. Switching point mode
A1 A2 A1
0.0
Output 2
N. C.
Series
LUC
Falling ramp A2 A2
N. C. (A1 > A2):
A1
-0.1 A1 A2 Output 1
A1 N. O.
Round bar, Ø 25 mm Zero line Output 2 A1
A2 A2
-0.2
0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 A1 , A2 : Object presence detection
Double sheet
A1 = 0 A2 Object-
monitoring
Y Distance X [m] Both outputs are active if Object within detection range.
presence
X Detection-
wide sonic beam A1, A2
Switching window and switching point: limit
narrow sonic beam
Output 1
A1 A2 2. Window mode
Output 1
A2 A1
N. O.
Output 2 prog. with A1 key A2 > A1
A3 A1 A2
Power supplies
Output 2
A3 N. C.
A1> A2
Note: A2 A1
means: cover transducer surface with your hand,
while programming the output. 3. Hysteresis mode
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
N. O.
A1 > A2
A2 A1
Accessories
Note:
means: cover transducer surface with your hand,
while teaching the switching point.
If A1 = A2, the output works like A2 > A1
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 137
Ultrasonic sensor UB1500-F42(S)-UK-V95
-12GM
Series
• TEACH-IN
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB1500-F42 S-UK-V95
UB1500-F42 -UK-V95
Model number
Series
-F42
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
138 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB1500-F42(S)-UK-V95
-12GM
Series
15 7.5 5.2 15 7.5 5.2
7/8"-16 UN 2A
7/8"-16 UN 2A
15.5
15.5
-18GK/-18GM
Membrane keys Membrane keys
22
Series
A2
A2
52.5
52.5
TEACH IN
TEACH IN
MODE
MODE
34
34
80
80
65
65
A1
A1
LED window LED window
5
16 16
Series
-30GM
10 65 10 65
34 80 34 80
VariKont
22
Series
Series
-FP
Housing version -F42 Housing version -F 42S
Electrical connection
Series
-F12
Standard symbol/Connections:
1 AC/DC
U 5
20 V ... 253 V
4
Series
max. 250 V AC/120 V DC
-F42
2
Imax = 3 A
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Diagrams
Series
1. Switch point operation
-D1
Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20 normally open
0.8
A1 -> ∞
A2
0.6
A1
LUC
0.2
0 0 2. Window operation
2 1
-0.2 normally open
Double sheet
A1 < A2
monitoring
-0.4 -10 A1 A2
-0.6
normally closed
-0.8 A2 < A1 A2 A1
-20
1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 2.0 2.2 2.4
Distance [m]
3. Hysteresis operation
Power supplies
Control units/
normally closed
A2 < A1 A2 A1
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 139
Ultrasonic sensor UB2000-F42(S)-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Synchronisation options
• 1 Switch output
UB2000-F42(S)-E4-V15
Series
-30GM
UB2000-F42(S)-E5-V15
• 2 independent switch outputs
UB2000-F42(S)-E6-V15
UB2000-F42(S)-E7-V15
VariKont
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB2000-F42 S-E4-V15
UB2000-F42 S-E5-V15
UB2000-F42 S-E6-V15
UB2000-F42 S-E7-V15
UB2000-F42 S-U-V15
UB2000-F42 -E4-V15
UB2000-F42 -E5-V15
UB2000-F42 -E6-V15
UB2000-F42 -E7-V15
UB2000-F42 S-I-V15
UB2000-F42 -U-V15
UB2000-F42 -I-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
LED yellow 2 permanent: switching state switch output 2, flashing: TEACH-IN function ! ! ! !
-F54
Repeat accuracy ! ! ! ! ! ! ! !
LUC
≤ 30 Hz
Control units/
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; foam polyurethane, cover PBT ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! !
Mass 140 g ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
140 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB2000-F42(S)-...-V15
-12GM
Series
15 7.5 5.2 15 7.5 5.2
15.5
15.5
-18GK/-18GM
Membrane keys Membrane keys
22
M12x1
M12x1
Series
A2
A2
52.5
52.5
SET
TEACH IN
SET
TEACH IN
34
34
MODE
MODE
80
80
65
65
A1
A1
5
16 16
Series
-30GM
10 65 10 65
34 80 34 80
22
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Housing version -F42 Housing version -F42S
Electrical connection
Series
-F12
Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections:
(version E4, npn) (version E6, pnp) (version I)
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) + UB
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 2 (WH)
Switch output Sync. Teaching input
U 2 (WH) U 4 (BK) U 5 (GY)
Teaching input Switch output 1 Sync.
Series
5 (GY) 2 (WH) 4 (BK)
-F42
Synchronous Switch output 2 Analog output
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F43
Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections:
(version E5, pnp) (version E7, npn) (version U)
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) 1 (BN)
+ UB + UB
2 (WH) Teaching input 4 (BK) 2 (WH)
Switch output 1 Teaching input
U 5 (GY) U 2 (WH) U 5 (GY)
Synchronous Switch output 2 Sync.
Series
4 (BK) 5 (GY) 4 (BK)
Switch output Sync.
-F54
Analog output
3 (BU)
- UB 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Diagrams output versions -I and -U output versions -E6 and E7 output versions -E4 and -E5
Series
-D1
Distance Y [m]
1
Object distance
Flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
Object distance
Object distance
0.5 N. O. (A1 < A2):
Rising ramp
Output 1 1. Switching point mode
0 A1 A2 A1
Output 2
N. C.
Series
LUC
Falling ramp A2 A2
-0.5 N. C. (A1 > A2):
A1
Round bar, Ø 25 mm A1 A2 Output 1
-1
A1 N. O.
Zero line Output 2 A1
0.0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5
A2 A2
Distance X [m] A1 , A2 : Object presence detection
Double sheet
A1 = 0 A2 Object-
monitoring
Output 2
A3 N. C.
A1> A2
Note: A2 A1
means: cover transducer surface with your hand,
while programming the output. 3. Hysteresis mode
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
N. O.
A1 > A2
A2 A1
Accessories
Note:
means: cover transducer surface with your hand,
while teaching the switching point.
If A1 = A2, the output works like A2 > A1
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 141
Ultrasonic sensor UB3000-F42-UK-V95
-12GM
Series
• TEACH-IN
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB3000-F42 -UK-V95
Model number
Series
-F42
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
142 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB3000-F42-UK-V95
-12GM
Series
15 7.5 5.2
-18GK/-18GM
Series
7/8"-16 UN 2A
15.5
Membrane keys 30
A2
52.5
TEACH IN
MODE
34
Series
-30GM
80
65
A1
LED window
5 16
VariKont
Series
10 65
34 80
Series
-FP
Electrical connection
Series
-F12
Standard symbol/Connections:
1 AC/DC
U 5
20 V ... 253 V
4
Series
max. 250 V AC/120 V DC
-F42
2
Imax = 3 A
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Diagrams
Series
1. Switch point operation
-D1
Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
20 normally open
1.5 A1 -> ∞
A2
1.0
10 normally closed
A2 -> ∞
Series
A1
LUC
0.5
2 1
0 0 2. Window operation
A1 < A2
monitoring
-10 A1 A2
-1.0
normally closed
-1.5
A2 < A1 A2 A1
-20
2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0
Distance [m]
3. Hysteresis operation
Power supplies
Control units/
normally closed
A2 < A1 A2 A1
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 143
Ultrasonic sensor UB4000-F42-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Synchronisation options
• 1 Switch output
UB4000-F42-E4-V15
Series
-30GM
UB4000-F42-E5-V15
• 2 independent switch outputs
UB4000-F42-E6-V15
UB4000-F42-E7-V15
VariKont
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB4000-F42 -E4-V15
UB4000-F42 -E5-V15
UB4000-F42 -E6-V15
UB4000-F42 -E7-V15
UB4000-F42 -U-V15
UB4000-F42 -I-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Voltage drop ! ! ! !
LUC
0 level -UB...+1 V
1 level: +4 V...+UB
input impedance: > 12 KOhm
synchronisation pulse: ≥ 100 µs, synchronisation interpulse period: ≥ 2 ms
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-12GM
Series
15 7.5 5.2
-18GK/-18GM
Series
15.5
Membrane keys 30
M12x1
A2
52.5
TEACH IN
SET
34
Series
-30GM
MODE
80
65
A1
LED window
5 16
VariKont
Series
10 65
34 80
Series
-FP
Electrical connection
Series
-F12
Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections:
(version E4, npn) (version E5, pnp) (version U)
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) 1 (BN)
+ UB + UB
4 (BK) 2 (WH) 2 (WH)
Switch output Teaching input Teaching input
U 2 (WH) U 5 (GY) U 5 (GY)
Teaching input Synchronous Sync.
Series
5 (GY) 4 (BK) 4 (BK)
-F42
Synchronous Switch output Analog output
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F43
Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections: Standard symbol/Connections:
(version I) (version E6, pnp) (version E7, npn)
1 (BN) + UB 1 (BN) 1 (BN)
+ UB + UB
2 (WH) 5 (GY) 4 (BK)
Teaching input Sync. Switch output 1
U 5 (GY) U 4 (BK) U 2 (WH)
Sync. Switch output 1 Switch output 2
4 (BK)
Series
2 (WH) 5 (GY)
Analog output Sync.
-F54
Switch output 2
3 (BU) 3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB - UB
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Diagrams output versions -I and -U output versions -E6 and E7 output versions -E4 and -E5
Series
-D1
Distance Y [m]
2
Flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm Object distance
1.5
Object distance
1 Object distance
N. O. (A1 < A2):
0.5
Rising ramp
Output 1 1. Switching point mode
0 A1 A2 A1
Output 2
N. C.
Series
-0.5
LUC
Falling ramp A2 A2
N. C. (A1 > A2):
-1 A1
A1 A2 Output 1
-1.5 A1
Round bar, Ø 25 mm N. O.
-2 Zero line Output 2 A1
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
A2 A2
Distance X [m] A1 , A2 : Object presence detection
Double sheet
A1 = 0 A2 Object-
monitoring
Output 2
A3 N. C.
A1> A2
Note: A2 A1
means: cover transducer surface with your hand,
while programming the output. 3. Hysteresis mode
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
N. O.
A1 > A2
A2 A1
Accessories
Note:
means: cover transducer surface with your hand,
while teaching the switching point.
If A1 = A2, the output works like A2 > A1
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 145
Series -F42 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Safety notes:
The supply circuit is separated from the relay circuit by basic insulation.
Safety class II is only guaranteed when using the accessorial connector cable. The connector cable may only
be separated from the unit when the power is off.
Series
-30GM
CAUTION:
The UB...-F42(S)-UK-V95 ultrasonic sensor is not suitable for use in environments subject to explo-
sion hazards.
VariKont
Series
Conformity: EN 60947-5-2
Housing insulation: Safety class II
Degree of contamination: 3
Overvoltage category: III
Series
-FP
Parameterisation:
You can use 2 keys to parameterise the sensor. In order to start the switch point 1 learning mode, press the A1 key; in order
to start the switch point 2 learning mode, press the A1 key.
If you keep both keys pressed as you switch on the power supply, the sensor will switch over to the sensitivity adjustment mode
Series
-F12
of operation.
In case the parameterisation procedure is not completed within 5 minutes, the sensor will discontinue the process and retain
all previous settings.
Teaching in switch points:
Series
-F42
Keep A1 key pressed for The sensor enters the switch point 1 learning
Series
-F43
> 2s mode
Position target object in the The sensor indicates via LED lights whether the
desired distance target object has been detected. In case the
object has been detected, the yellow LED will
Series
-F54
Briefly press the A1 key The sensor completes the switch point 1
Series
Keep both A1 and A2 keys The sensor indicates the current operation mode
pressed through the green LED.
Series
LUC
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
146 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F42 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Suppression of disturbing targets
Some types of installation or particular conditions during operation of an ultrasonic sensor may admit that undesired objects
-18GK/-18GM
(such as shelf brow posts, edges of machines) are closer than the actual target as they enter the recording range. In this case,
Series
the sensor would normally detect these objects rather than the desired target. So in order to ensure an error-free operation, in
may be necessary to suppress those objects.
Objects can be suppressed if they meet the following conditions:
- The disturbing target must not hide the actual target completely.
- The amplitude of the disturbing signal must be smaller than the amplitude of the desired signal.
Series
-30GM
- The disturbing target must remain in the edge region of the sound lobe and must not enter its center.
Sound lobe
VariKont
Series
Centre of
sound lobe
Target
Series
object object
-FP
The suppression of the disturbing target is effected through reduction of the response sensitivity. This figure shows its effect
on the response characteristics of the sensor. The sensor is preset on step 1 by the manufacturer.
100 %
Series
-F12
Step 1
50 %
Step 4
Step 20 Step 12
Step 17
Step 21
Series
-F42
50 %
Series
100 %
-F43
25 % 50 % 75 % 100 %
Series
-F54
Keep A1 and A2 keys The sensor enters the sensitivity adjustment mode
pressed as you switch of operation.
on power supply The sensor sensitivity can be adjusted in 24 steps.
Step 1 = high response
Series
-F64
Step 24 = low response
Br iefly press the A1 key Response is increased. The LED lights indicate the
actual state of the sensor.
- flashing red: no disturbing target detected
Series
-D1
- flashing yellow: disturbing target detected
- permanent red: upper setting limit is reached.
Br iefly press the A2 key Response is decreased. The LED lights indicate the
Series
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 147
Series -F42 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Functional Description
The sensor may be completely parameterised via two keys on the side panel of the housing. As a special feature provided by
this sensor, the ultrasound beam width may be adapted to the environmental conditions at the place of operation of the sensor.
Default settings
Series
-30GM
Holding down the A1key > 2 The sensor switches to learn mode and the user may
seconds specify the A1 switching point
Series
Positioning the target object The yellow LED of the sensor flashes fast to indicate
-F12
at the desired distance that the target object has been recognised. The red
LED flashes if the object has not been recognised.
Briefly pressing the A1 key The sensor terminates the specification of the A1
Series
The A2 switching point is specified via the A2 key, analogous to the description above.
Series
-F43
Alternatively, the switching points may also be specified electrically via the learn input. To specify the A1 switching point, the
learn input must be connected to
-UB ; to specify the A2 switching point, it must be connected to +U B . Specified values are saved upon the disconnection from
the learn input.
Series
Switching points may only be specified directly after Power on. A time lock secures the adjusted switching points against un-
-F54
intended modification 5 minutes after the last keypress. To modify the switching points later, the user may specify the desired
values only after a new Power On.
Proceed as follows to parameterise the output function and the ultrasound beam width:
Series
-F64
Press the A1 key during Power on and hold down the key for another second to ensure that the sensor starts the two-step
parameterisation of the operating modes.
kes of the A2 key. These strokes are visualised via short flashes of the green LED.
pause
object detection
Window function
pause
(default)
Double sheet
monitoring
Hysteresis mode
pause
Hold down the A1 key for 2 seconds to save the selected output mode, complete the parameterisation and ensure that the
Power supplies
Control units/
sensor returns to normal mode. Step 2 may be initiated by briefly pressing the A1 key (parameterisation of the ultrasound beam
width).
Date of edi ti on 0 8/17/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
148 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F42 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Step 2, parameterisation of the ultrasound beam width
In the near range, via Step 2, the ultrasound beam width may be adapted to the requirements of the corresponding application.
-18GK/-18GM
The beam width parameterised last is displayed first. Available beam width settings may be selected via consecutive, brief stro-
Series
kes of the A2 key. These strokes are visualised via the flash sequence of the red LED.
Small beam
Series
-30GM
pause
Medium beam
pause
VariKont
Series
Large beam
pause
Hold down the A1 key for 2 seconds to save the selected beam shape, complete the parameterisation and ensure that the
Series
sensor returns to normal mode. Briefly press the A1 key to return to Step 1 (parameterisation of the output function).
-FP
If the parameterisation mode is not terminated within 5 minutes after last keypress (by holding down the A1 key for 2 seconds),
Series
the sensor aborts this mode without modifying the settings.
-F12
Synchronisation
The sensor has a synchronisation port to suppress mutual influencing. If this port has not been connected, the sensor works
at an internally generated cycle rate. Several sensors may be synchronised via the following options.
Series
External synchronisation:
-F42
The sensor may be synchronised via the external application of a square wave voltage. A synchronisation pulse on the syn-
chronisation input initiates a measuring cycle. The pulse width must be greater than 100 µs. The measuring cycle is started
with the falling edge. A low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input initiate the transition to normal sensor mode. A high
level on the synchronisation input deactivates the sensor.
Series
-F43
Two modes are possible:
- Several sensors are controlled via the same synchronisation signal. The sensors work in common mode.
- The synchronisation pulses are forwarded at cyclic intervals to respectively one single sensor. The sensors work in mul-
tiplex mode.
Self-synchronisation:
Series
-F54
The synchronisation ports of up to 5 sensors suitable for self-synchronisation are connected to each other. These sensors work
in multiplex mode after Power on. The On delay increases depending on the number of sensors to be synchronised. While the
learn mode is active, no synchronisation is possible (and vice-versa). To specify the switching points, the sensors must be ope-
rated in non-synchronised mode.
Series
-F64
Note:
If the synchronisation option is not used, the synchronisation input must be connected to ground (0V) or the sensor must be
operated with a (4-pole) V1 connecting cable.
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 149
Series -F42 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Functional description
The sensor can be completely parameterised using 2 keys on the side of the housing. One special feature of this sensor is the
option of adapting the ultrasonic beam width to the ambient conditions at the place where the sensor is used.
Default settings
Series
-30GM
Press key A1 > 2 seconds The sensor goes into learning mode for switching point
A1
Series
Position the target object at The sensor indicates by rapid flashing of the yellow
-F12
the desired distance LED that the target object has been detected. If no ob-
ject is detected, the red LED flashes.
Press key A1 briefly The sensor completes the Teach-in process for switch-
Series
The process for Teach-in of switching point A2 is similar to what was described above, using key A2.
Series
In the case of the output function (operating mode) "Window + switching point“ (see below), switching points A1 and A2 define
the window limits of switch output 1.
A third switching point A3 can also be defined here at which switch output 2 switches.
Series
Press key A1 + A2 > 2 sec- The sensor goes into learning mode for switching point
onds A3
Series
-F64
Position the target object at The sensor indicates by rapid flashing of the yellow
the desired distance LEDs that the target object has been detected. If no ob-
ject is detected, the red LED flashes.
Press key A1 briefly The sensor completes the Teach-in process for switch-
Series
-D1
(output 2: normally closed) ing point A3 and stores the value in permanent memo-
ry.
or If the object is uncertain (red LED lit irregularly) the
Teach-in value is not valid. Teach-in mode closes.
Press key A2 briefly
Series
LUC
If you press the A1 key while the power supply is being turned on and then hold it down for 1 second, the sensor goes into the
two-level parameterisation of operating modes.
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
150 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F42 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Level 1, parametrisation of the output function
Pressing the A2 key briefly will cause the possible output functions to be selected one after the other (depending on the last
-18GK/-18GM
output function to be parameterised). The functions are indicated by a flashing sequence of the green LED.
Series
Operating mode Flashing sequence of green LED A2 key
Series
-30GM
2 x normally closed func-
Pause
tion
2 switching points
VariKont
Series
Pause
n.o. (output 1) +
n.c. (output 2)
Window (output 1) +
Pause
switching point (output 2)
Series
-FP
Pressing the A1 key for 2 seconds saves the selected output operating mode. The parameter assignment process is then com-
plete and the sensor returns to normal mode. If you press the A1 key briefly instead, you go to Level 2 (parameter assignment
of ultrasonic beam range).
Series
-F12
Level 2, parameter assignment of ultrasonic beam width
The ultrasonic beam width can be adjusted to match the requirements of the application in Level 2.
Pressing the A2 key briefly will cause the possible beam widths to be selected one after the other (depending on the last beam
width to be parameterised). The functions are indicated by a flashing sequence of the red LED.
Series
-F42
Beam width Flashing sequence of red LED A2 key
Series
-F43
Average beam width
Pause
Wide beam
Pause
(default)
Series
-F54
Pressing the A1 key for 2 seconds saves the selected type of beam width. The parameter assignment process is then complete
and the sensor returns to normal mode. If you press the A1 briefly instead, you go back to Level 1 (parameter assignment of
output function).
Series
-F64
If parameterisation is not complete within 5 minutes (pressing the A1 key for 2 seconds), the sensor interrupts parameterisation
mode without changing the settings.
Series
-D1
Synchronisation
The sensor is equipped with a synchronisation connection to suppress mutual interaction. If it is not turned on, the sensor works
at an internally generated cycle rate. Synchronisation of more than one sensor is possible in a number of different ways.
External synchronisation:
Series
LUC
The sensor can be synchronised by the application of a square wave voltage externally. A synchronisation pulse on the syn-
chronisation input results in the execution of a measurement cycle. The pulse width must be greater than 100 µs. The measu-
rement cycle must be started with the falling signal edge. A Low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input results in normal
operation of the sensor. A High level on the synchronisation input deactivates the sensor.
Double sheet
monitoring
sensors work after turning on the operating voltage in Multiplex mode. The On delay increases depending on the number of
sensors to be synchronised. Synchronisation is possible during Teach-in and vice-versa. Sensors must be operated unsyn-
chronised to perform Teach-in of switching points.
Note:
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input can be connected with ground (0 V) or the sensor can
be operated with a V1 connection cable (4-pin).
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 151
Series -F42 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Functional description
The sensor can be completely parameterised using 2 keys on the side of the housing. One special feature of this sensor is the
option of adapting the ultrasonic beam width to the ambient conditions at the place where the sensor is used.
Default settings
Series
-30GM
Press key A1 > 2 seconds The sensor goes into learning mode for switching point
A1
Series
Position the target object at The sensor indicates by rapid flashing of the yellow
-F12
the desired distance LED that the target object has been detected. If no ob-
ject is detected, the red LED flashes.
Press key A1 briefly The sensor completes the Teach-in process for switch-
Series
The process for Teach-in of switching point A2 is similar to what was described above, using key A2.
Series
In the case of the output function (operating mode) "Window + switching point“ (see below), switching points A1 and A2 define
the window limits of switch output 1.
A third switching point A3 can also be defined here at which switch output 2 switches.
Series
Press key A1 + A2 > 2 sec- The sensor goes into learning mode for switching point
onds A3
Series
-F64
Position the target object at The sensor indicates by rapid flashing of the yellow
the desired distance LEDs that the target object has been detected. If no ob-
ject is detected, the red LED flashes.
Press key A1 briefly The sensor completes the Teach-in process for switch-
Series
-D1
(output 2: normally closed) ing point A3 and stores the value in permanent memo-
ry.
or If the object is uncertain (red LED lit irregularly) the
Teach-in value is not valid. Teach-in mode closes.
Press key A2 briefly
Series
LUC
If you press the A1 key while the power supply is being turned on and then hold it down for 1 second, the sensor goes into the
two-level parameterisation of operating modes.
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
152 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F42 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
Level 1, parametrisation of the output function
Pressing the A2 key briefly will cause the possible output functions to be selected one after the other (depending on the last
-18GK/-18GM
output function to be parameterised). The functions are indicated by a flashing sequence of the green LED.
Series
Operating mode Flashing sequence of green LED A2 key
Series
-30GM
2 x normally closed func-
Pause
tion
2 switching points
VariKont
Series
Pause
n.o. (output 1) +
n.c. (output 2)
Window (output 1) +
Pause
switching point (output 2)
Series
-FP
Pressing the A1 key for 2 seconds saves the selected output operating mode. The parameter assignment process is then com-
plete and the sensor returns to normal mode. If you press the A1 key briefly instead, you go to Level 2 (parameter assignment
of ultrasonic beam range).
Series
-F12
Level 2, parameter assignment of ultrasonic beam width
The ultrasonic beam width can be adjusted to match the requirements of the application in Level 2.
Pressing the A2 key briefly will cause the possible beam widths to be selected one after the other (depending on the last beam
width to be parameterised). The functions are indicated by a flashing sequence of the red LED.
Series
-F42
Beam width Flashing sequence of red LED A2 key
Series
-F43
Average beam width
Pause
Wide beam
Pause
(default)
Series
-F54
Pressing the A1 key for 2 seconds saves the selected type of beam width. The parameter assignment process is then complete
and the sensor returns to normal mode. If you press the A1 briefly instead, you go back to Level 1 (parameter assignment of
output function).
Series
-F64
If parameterisation is not complete within 5 minutes (pressing the A1 key for 2 seconds), the sensor interrupts parameterisation
mode without changing the settings.
Series
-D1
Synchronisation
The sensor is equipped with a synchronisation connection to suppress mutual interaction. If it is not turned on, the sensor works
at an internally generated cycle rate. Synchronisation of more than one sensor is possible in a number of different ways.
External synchronisation:
Series
LUC
The sensor can be synchronised by the application of a square wave voltage externally. A synchronisation pulse on the syn-
chronisation input results in the execution of a measurement cycle. The pulse width must be greater than 100 µs. The measu-
rement cycle must be started with the falling signal edge. A Low level > 1 s or an open synchronisation input results in normal
operation of the sensor. A High level on the synchronisation input deactivates the sensor.
Double sheet
monitoring
sensors work after turning on the operating voltage in Multiplex mode. The On delay increases depending on the number of
sensors to be synchronised. Synchronisation is possible during Teach-in and vice-versa. Sensors must be operated unsyn-
chronised to perform Teach-in of switching points.
Note:
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
If the option for synchronisation is not used, the synchronisation input can be connected with ground (0 V) or the sensor can
be operated with a V1 connection cable (4-pin).
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 153
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
154 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F43
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
UC2000-F43-2KIR2-V17 UC300-F43-2KIR2-V17
Series
-F42
Model number Detection range Page
Series
-F43
UC300-F43-2KIR2-V17 300 mm 156
UC2000-F43-2KIR2-V17 2000 mm
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 9/13/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 155
Ultrasonic sensor UC...-F43-2KIR2-V17
-12GM
Series
• Serial interface
Series
• Temperature compensation
• Reverse polarity protection
• Parameterisable with ULTRA 2001
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC2000-F43 -2KIR2-V17
UC300-F43-2KIR2-V1 7
Model number
Series
-F42
0 mm !
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm ! !
Transducer frequency approx. 175 kHz !
approx. 390 kHz !
Response delay minimum (EM; NONE): ≤20 ms (2 measuring cycles) !
factory setting (EM, MXN, 5, 2): ≤60 ms (6 measuring cycles)
Series
-F54
≤ 500 Ω at UB ≥ 17V
≤ 200 Ω at UB < 17V
Range hysteresis 0 ... 15 % parameterisable with ULTRA2001 ! !
Contact loading 60 V DC / 1 A (max. 24 W DC), ohmic !
Double sheet
monitoring
Mass 290 g ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
156 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC...-F43-2KIR2-V17
-12GM
Series
LED window 22 LED window 22
5.5
5.5
-18GK/-18GM
Series
13
13
Series
-30GM
100
100
117
117
100
100
134
134
VariKont
Series
M4 M4
Bore holes for thread M4 Bore holes for thread M4
(The delivery includes 4 pcs.) (The delivery includes 4 pcs.)
41 5.5 30 41 5.5 30
Series
52 52
-FP
Transducer 14 mm countersunk Transducer 5 mm countersunk
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
2
-F43
(BN)
+UB
1 (WH)
U 4 (YE)
6 (PK)
7 (BU)
-UB
3 (GN)
RxD
Series
5 (GY)
-F54
TxD
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Basic setting Characteristic response curve Basic setting
OM: OM:
Distance Y [m] Distance Y [m]
Relay 1: NO 0.5
Relay 1: NO
0.15
Relay 2: NO Relay 2: NO
Double sheet
monitoring
0.4
0.10 SD1/SD2: SD1/SD2:
0.3
Switch point relay 1 = 25 mm Switch point relay 1 = 100 mm
Switch point relay 2 = 50 mm 0.2 Switch point relay 2 = 2000 mm
0.05
0.1
2 NDE/FDE: NDE/FDE:
2 1
0.00 Analogue output: 4 mA ⇒ 25 mm 0.0 Analogue output: 4 mA ⇒ 100 mm
1 20 mA ⇒ 300 mm -0.1 20 mA ⇒ 2000 mm
-0.05 FSF: -0.2 FSF:
⇒ Relay 1 and 2: ⇒ Relay 1 and 2: latest state
Power supplies
-0.3
-0.10 ⇒ Analogue output: IOUT = 3,9 mA ⇒ Analogue output: IOUT = 3,9 mA
-0.4
NEF: NEF:
-0.5
-0.15
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 No echo ⇒ error message 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 No echo ⇒ error message
Y Distance X [m] Y Distance X [m]
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
MA,S: MA,S:
X Switching mode X Switching mode
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
Accessories
UC300-F43-2KIR2-V17 UC2000-F43-2KIR2-V17
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 157
Series -F43 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UC300-F43-2KIR2-V17
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Thanks to its extensive command set, the sensor can be configured to suit the application via the RS 232 interface.
RS 232 command set (overview)
Command Meaning Parameter Access
VS0 Velocity of Sound at 0 °C Velocity of sound at 0 °centigrade VS0 in [cm/s] {10000 ... 60000) r ead and set
Series
-30GM
SD1 Switching Distance 1 Switching point, relay 1 SD1 in [mm] { 1 ... 800} r ead and set
SD2 Switching Distance 2 Switching point, relay 2 SD2 in [mm] {1 ... 800} r ead and set
SH1 Switching Hysteresis 1 Hysteresis, relay 1 in [%] {0 ... 15} r ead and set
SH2 Switching Hysteresis 2 Hysteresis, relay 2 in [%] {0 ... 15} r ead and set
Series
-FP
NDE Near Distance ofEvaluation Near measuring window limit in [mm] {1 ... 800} r ead and set
FDE Far Distance of Evaluation Far measuring window limit in [mm]{1 ... 800} r ead and set
BR Unusable area (Blind Range) Unusable ar ea in [mm] {0 ... 800} r ead and set
RR Range Reduction reduces sensing range [mm] {0 ... 800} r ead and set
Series
-F12
CON CONservative filter Counter threshold as number {0 ... 255} r ead and set
-F42
OM Output Mode OM coded [nor mally-open = 0, normally-closed = 1, inactive = I] r ead and set
FSF Fail Safe Function Failur e function type e.g. FSF,11,35 {0,1,2}, [fault current in 0.1 mA], -1 = cur rent r ead and set
output indifferently
MD Master Device Function as master r ead and set
Series
-F43
{0 = NONE},AD,RD,RT,SS,ADB,RDB,RTB }
MA Main Application Determines whether the green LED orients on analogue output or switching outputs r ead and set
{A,S}
NEF No Echo Failure Sensor behaviour when no echo is present {0,1} r ead and set
Series
-F54
SS1 Switching State 1 SS1 binary [0: inactive, 1 active] ( independent of OM) r ead
-F64
SS2 Switching State 2 SS2 binary [0: inactive, 1 active] ( independent of OM) r ead
ADB Absolute Distance Binary Distance in [mm] not as ASCII r ead
RDB Relative Distance Binary Relative distance as number {0 ... 4095} not as ASCII r ead
RTB RunTime Binar y Echo run time in machine cycles [1 machine cycle = 1.085 µs] not as ASCII r ead
Series
-D1
Time: 11:14:35
ST STatus Status as hexadecimal string r ead
RST ReSeT Performs a reset Command
Double sheet
monitoring
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
158 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F43 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UC2000-F43-2KIR2-V17
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Thanks to its extensive command set, the sensor can be configured to suit the application via the RS 232 interface.
RS 232 com mand set (overview)
Command Meaning Parameter Access
VS0 Velocity of Sound at 0 °C Velocity of sound at 0 °centigrade VS0 in [cm/s] {12000 ... 60000) read and set
Series
-30GM
VS Velocity of Sound Velocity of sound VS in [cm/s] read
TO Temperature Offset TO in [0.1K] read and set
TEM TEMperature TEM in [0.1K] read and adapt to TO
VariKont
REF REFerence measurement REF distance in [mm] {100 ... 4000} adaptation of VS0
Series
SD1 Switching Distance 1 Switching point, relay 1 SD1 in [mm] read and set
{100 ... 4000}
SD2 Switching Distance 2 Switching point, relay 2 SD1 in [mm] read and set
{100 ... 4000}
Series
SH1 Switching Hysteresis 1 Hysteresis, relay 1 in [%] {0 ... 15} read and set
-FP
SH2 Switching Hysteresis 2 Hysteresis, relay 2 in [%] {0 ... 15} read and set
NDE Near Distance of Evaluation Near measur ing window limit in [mm] read and set
{100 ... 4000}
Series
FDE Far Distance of Evaluation Far measuring window limit in [mm] read and set
-F12
{100 ... 4000}
BR Unusable area (Blind Range) Unusable area in [mm] {0 ... 4000} read and set
RR Range Reduction reduces sensing r ange [in mm] {100 ... 4000} read and set
CBT Constant Burst Time Burst length {0,1, 2, 3} read and set
Series
-F42
CCT Constant Cycle Time Time in [ms] {0 ... 1000} read and set
FTO Filter TimeOut Number of measurements without echo to be filtered {0 ... 255} read and set
EM Evaluation Method Evaluation method { 0 = NONE; PT1[,f,p,c]; MXN[,m,n]; DYN[,p] } read and set
CON CONservative filter Counter thr eshold as number {0 ... 255} read and set
Series
-F43
OM Output Mode OM coded [normally- open = 0, normally-closed = 1, inactive = I] read and set
FSF Fail Safe Function Failure function type e.g. FSF,11,35 {0,1,2} , [fault curr ent in 0.1 mA], -1 = current read and set
output indifferently
MD Master Device Function as master read and set
Series
{0 = NONE},AD,RD,RT,SS,ADB,RDB,RTB }
-F54
MA Main Application Determines whether the green LED orients on analogue output or switching outputs read and set
{A,S}
NEF No Echo Failur e Sensor behaviour when no echo is present {0,1} read and set
AD Absolute Distance Distance in [mm] read
Series
-F64
RD Relative Distance Relative distance as number { 0 ... 4095} read
RT RunTime Echo run time in machine cycles read
[1 machine cycle = 1.085µs]
SS1 Switching State 1 SS1 binar y [0: inactive, 1 active] (independent of OM) read
Series
-D1
SS2 Switching State 2 SS2 binar y [0: inactive, 1 active] read
(independent of OM)
ADB Absolute Distance Binary Distance in [mm] not as ASCII read
RDB Relative Distance Binar y Relative distance as number { 0 ... 4095} read
not as ASCII
Series
LUC
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 159
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
160 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F54
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
Model number Description Detection range Page
-F42
UB500-F54-E4-V15 Switching output 500 mm 162
UB500-F54-E5-V15 500 mm
UB2000-F54-E4-V15 2000 mm
Series
-F43
UB2000-F54-E5-V15 2000 mm
UB500-F54-I-V15 Analogue output 500 mm 164
UB500-F54-U-V15 500 mm
Series
-F54
UB2000-F54-I-V15 2000 mm
UB2000-F54-U-V15 2000 mm
UB500-F54-H3-V1 For exter nal control/evaluation unit 500 mm 166
Series
-F64
UB2000-F54-H3-V1 2000 mm
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 161
Ultrasonic sensor UB...-F54-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• Switch output
• 5 different output functions can be set
-18GK/-18GM
• TEACH-IN input
Series
• Synchronisation options
• Deactivation option
• Temperature compensation
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB2000-F54 -E4-V15
UB2000-F54 -E5-V15
UB500-F54-E4-V15
UB500-F54-E5-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
0 ... 80 mm ! !
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm ! ! ! !
Transducer frequency approx. 175 kHz ! !
approx. 380 kHz ! !
Response delay ≤ 150 ms ! !
≤ 50 ms ! !
Series
-F54
≤3 V
-D1
Voltage drop ! ! ! !
Switching frequency max. 10 Hz ! !
max. 3 Hz ! !
Range hysteresis ≤ 1 % of the set operating distance ! ! ! !
Repeat accuracy ≤ 1 % of full-scale value ! ! ! !
Series
≤ 33 Hz
Control units/
! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 100 / n Hz, n = number of sensors ! !
≤ 33 / n Hz, n = number of sensors ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! ! !
Protection degree IP65 ! ! ! !
Connection connector V15 (M12 x 1), 5 pin ! ! ! !
Accessories
Material
Housing ABS ! ! ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam ! ! ! !
Mass 100 g ! ! ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
162 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB...-F54-...-V15
-12GM
Series
120 120
105 105
94
-18GK/-18GM
94
Series
32
21
32
21
Series
-30GM
Bore hole and countersinking Bore hole and countersinking
for screws/hexagon M4 for screws/hexagon M4
3.5
3.5
VariKont
Series
25
25
3.5
3.5
Series
-FP
UB500-F54-... UB2000-F54-...
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN) 1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB + UB
4 (BK) 2 (WH)
Switch output Teaching input
U 2 (WH) U 5 (GY)
Teaching input Synchronous
5 (GY) 4 (BK)
Synchronous Switch output
3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Characteristic response curve Programmed switching output function
1. Window mode, normally open function
Distance Y [m] Distance Y [m]
Double sheet
0.20 0.5
0.15
0.4 A1 A2
0.3 2. Window mode, normally closed function
0.10
0.2
A2 < A1:
1
0.05
0.1 A2 A1
2 2 1
Power supplies
0.0
A1 -> ∞:
-0.1
-0.05
-0.2 A2
-0.10
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-0.20 -0.5 A1
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5
Y Distance X [m] Y Distance X [m]
5. A1 -> ∞, A2 -> ∞: Detection of object presence
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 163
Ultrasonic sensor UB...-F54-...-V15
-12GM
Series
• Synchronisation options
Series
• Deactivation option
• Temperature compensation
• Analogue output 0 V ... 10 V
UB500-F54-U-V15
Series
-30GM
UB2000-F54-U-V15
• Analogue output 4 mA ... 20 mA
UB500-F54-I-V15
UB2000-F54-I-V15
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB2000-F54 -U-V15
UB500-F54-U-V15
UB2000-F54 -I-V15
UB500-F54-I-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
0 ... 80 mm ! !
-F43
≤ 33 Hz ! !
Multiplex operation ≤ 100 / n Hz, n = number of sensors ! !
≤ 33 / n Hz, n = number of sensors ! !
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 70 °C (248 ... 343 K) ! ! ! !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) ! ! ! !
Protection degree IP65 ! ! ! !
Connection connector V15 (M12 x 1), 5 pin ! ! ! !
Accessories
Material
Housing ABS ! ! ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam ! ! ! !
Mass 100 g ! ! ! !
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
164 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB...-F54-...-V15
-12GM
Series
120 120
105 105
94
-18GK/-18GM
94
Series
32
21
32
21
Series
-30GM
Bore hole and countersinking Bore hole and countersinking
for screws/hexagon M4 for screws/hexagon M4
3.5
3.5
VariKont
Series
25
25
3.5
3.5
Series
-FP
UB500-F54-... UB2000-F54-...
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 (BN) 1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB + UB
2 (WH) 2 (WH)
Teaching input Teaching input
U 5 (GY) U 5 (GY)
Synchronous Synchronous
4 (BK) 4 (BK)
Analog output Analog output
3 (BU) 3 (BU)
- UB - UB
Series
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2. Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curve Characteristic response curve Programmed analogue output function
Rising ramp
Distance Y [m] Distance Y [m]
Double sheet
A1 < A2:
monitoring
0.20 0.5
object range
0.15
0.4 A1 A2
0.3 Falling ramp
0.10
0.2
A2 < A1:
1
0.05
0.1
2 2 1 A2 A1
Power supplies
0.00
Control units/
0.0
-0.1
-0.05
-0.2
-0.10
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-0.3
-0.15
-0.4
-0.20 -0.5
0.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5
Y Distance X [m] Y Distance X [m]
Accessories
X X
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 165
Ultrasonic sensor UB...-F54-H3-V1
-12GM
Series
• Separate evaluation
• Direct detection mode
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UB2000-F54 -H3-V1
UB500-F54-H3-V1
Model number
Series
-F42
!
-F43
0 ... 80 mm 1)
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm ! !
Transducer frequency approx. 175 kHz !
approx. 380 kHz !
Operating voltage 10 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS ! !
≤ 30 mA
Series
Output type 1 pulse output for echo run time, short-circuit proof ! !
open collector pnp with pulldown resistor = 22 kOhm
level 0 (no echo): -UB
level 1 (echo detected): ≥ (+UB-2 V)
Rated operational current 15 mA , short-circuit/overload protected ! !
Series
-F64
Pulse length !
20 ... 300 µs (typ. 200 µs) 2)
!
5 ... 100 µs (typ. 50 µs) 2)
Pause length ≥ 50 x pulse length ! !
Impedance 10 kOhm internal connected to +UB ! !
Series
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! !
LUC
Material
Housing ABS ! !
Transducer epoxy resin/hollow glass sphere mixture; polyurethane foam ! !
Mass 110 g ! !
Power supplies
Control units/
Function
The sensing range is determined in the downstream evaluation electronics (e. g. the units UH3-KHD2-4E5, UH3-KHD2-4I or UH3-T1-KT). PLC
modules or other existing evaluation units can also be substituted for these units offered by Pepperl+Fuchs.
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
The object distance in pulse-echo mode is obtained from the echo time.
1)
The unusable area (blind range) BR depends on the pulse duration Ti .
The unusable area reaches a minimum with the shortest pulse duration.
Accessories
2)
The sensors detection range depends on the pulse duration Ti .
With pulse duration < typical pulse duration, the sensors detection range may be reduced.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
166 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UB...-F54-H3-V1
-12GM
Series
120 120
105 105
94
-18GK/-18GM
94
Series
32
21
32
21
Series
-30GM
Bore hole and countersinking Bore hole and countersinking
for screws/hexagon M4 for screws/hexagon M4
3.5
3.5
VariKont
Series
25
25
3.5
3.5
Series
-FP
UB500-F54-... UB2000-F54-...
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
1 (BN)
-F43
+ UB
2 (WH)
U Clock
4 (BK)
Echo
3 (BU)
- UB
Series
2 = Emitter pulse input
-F54
4 = Echo propagation time output
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
1.5
Distance Y [m]
0.3
1
0.2
0.5
0.1
Power supplies
1
Control units/
0 0
2 2 1
-0.1
-0.5
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
-0.2
-1
-0.3
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
Distance X [m]
Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm Curve 1: flat surface 100 mm x 100 mm
Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm Curve 2: round bar, Ø 25 mm
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 167
Series -F54 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
measuring cycle. Th e pulse must ha ve a duratio n greater than 1 00 µs. T he mea su ring cycle starts with the falling ed ge of a synchronisat ion pulse . A
low leve l > 1 s or a n open synchronisa tion in put will result in the no rma l op erat ion of the sen sor. A high level at the synchronisatio n input disables the
se nso r.
Tw o operating mo des are available
1. Mul tipl e sen sors ca n be co ntrol led by th e sam e synch ron isati on si gna l. Th e sen sors ar e synch ron ised .
VariKont
Series
2. The syn chro ni sation pul ses a re sen t cycl ical ly to in divi du al se nsor s. The se nso rs ope rate in multi ple x m ode .
Internal synchronisa tio n
The synchronisa tion co nnections of up to 5 sensors capa ble of internal synchronisatio n are connected to one an other. When power is applie d, these
se nso rs will ope rate in mu ltiplex mode. T he response delay increases acco rding to th e numbe r of sensors t o be syn chronised. Synchron isation canno t
be performed du ring T EACH -IN and vice versa. T he sensors m ust be ope rate d in an unsynchro nised manne r to t each the sw itching po int.
Series
-FP
No te:
If the o ptio n for synchronisa tio n is no t used, the synchronisa tio n in put has to be connected to ground (0V) or th e sensor h as to be o pera ted via a V1
ca ble co nnector (4-pin).
Ad justin g o f s witch ing p oin ts
The ult rasonic se nsor fe ature s a sw itch output with two teachable switching points. T hese are set by app lying the su pply voltage -U B or + UB to the
Series
-F12
TEAC H-I N inp ut. The supp ly vo ltag e m ust b e a pplied to the T EACH -IN input fo r at lea st 1 s. LEDs ind icate wh ether th e sen sor has recognised the target
during the T EACH-IN p rocedu re. Sw it ching p oin t A1 is taught w ith -U B , A2 w ith +UB .
Five differe nt outp ut functions can be set
1. Win dow m ode , n orma lly- ope n func ti on
2. Win dow m ode , n orma lly- close d fun cti on
Series
-F42
- C over sensor with ha nd or rem ove all o bje cts from sensing range
- T EACH -IN sw itch ing point A1 w ith -U B
- T EACH -IN sw itch ing point A2 w ith +UB
Double sheet
monitoring
Displays in dependence on operating mode Red LED Yellow LED Green LED
TEACH-IN switching point:
Object detected off flashes flashes
No object detected flashes off flashes
Date of edi ti on 0 8/17/20 05
state
Fault flashes previous off
state
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
168 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F54 Sensor function description
-12GM
Series
UB...-F54-... , output versions -I and -U
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Syn ch ron isation
T he se nso r features a synchron isation in put for the suppression of mutu al interferen ce . If this input is not used, the sensor w ill ope rate using an int ernally
gen erat ed clo ck rate. T he synchron isation of multip le sen sors can be realised as follow s:
External synchronisa tio n:
T he sensor ca n be synchron ised b y t he external applicat ion of a square w ave vo lta ge. A synchron isation pu lse at the synch ronisation input sta rts a
Series
-30GM
me asu ring cycle. T he p ulse m ust have a du ration g reate r tha n 100 µ s. The measuring cycle starts w ith the falling edge o f a synch ronisation pulse. A
low level > 1 s or an o pen synch ronisation input will resu lt in th e normal operation of t he sensor. A high level a t the synchron isation inpu t disab les th e
sensor.
T wo o pera ting modes are available:
1 . M ultip le se nso rs can b e con tro lle d by the s ame syn chro ni sation sign al . The se nso rs are syn chro nis ed.
VariKont
2 . Th e synch ron isa ti on p ulse s are se nt cyclic all y to i ndi vid ua l sens ors. Th e sen sors op era te in mu ltipl ex mo de.
Series
Inte rnal synchron isation:
T he synchronisation conne ctions of up to 5 se nso rs capable of inte rnal synchron isation a re conn ect ed to on e anoth er. Wh en pow er is app lied, th ese
sensors w ill operate in m ultiplex mod e.
T he response delay increases accord ing to the number of sensors to be synchro nised .
Synchro nisation cann ot be performed during TEAC H-IN and vice versa. T he sensors mu st be operated in an unsynchro nised m anner to teach th e eva-
Series
luation limit s.
-FP
N ote:
If th e option fo r synchron isation is not used , the synchron isation input has to be con nected to grou nd (0 V) or the sen sor has to b e operated via a V1
cable conne cto r (4-pin).
A dju sti ng th e eva luatio n ran ge (an alo gu e o utpu t)
Series
-F12
T he ultraso nic sensor has an a nalogue ou tput w ith prog ramm able evaluation limit s. T hese a re set by ap plying th e supply voltag e -U B or +UB to the
T EACH -IN input. T he supply voltage must be applied to the TEAC H-IN input for at least 1 s. LED s indica te wheth er the sensor has re cog nised the ta rget
during the TEACH -IN procedure. Th e lower evaluation lim it A1 is tau ght w ith -U B , A2 with + UB .
T wo d iffe rent o utput fu nction s can be set:
1 . A nal og ue va lue incre ase s with ri sing dista nce to ob je ct (ri sing r amp)
2 . A nal og ue va lue fa lls w ith risi ng d istan ce to obj ect (fa ll ing ra mpe )
Series
-F42
T EAC H-IN risin g ra mp (A 1 > A 2)
• Positio n object at lower evalua tio n limit
• T EACH -IN low er limit A1 w ith - UB
• Positio n object at up per evaluation limit
Series
-F43
• T EACH -IN upper limit A2 with + UB
T EAC H-IN fa lling ram p (A1 > A ):
• Positio n object at lower evalua tio n limit
• T EACH -IN low er limit A2 w ith + UB
Series
-F54
• Positio n object at up per evaluation limit
• T EACH -IN upper limit A1 with - UB
L ED D ispla ys
Series
-F64
Displays in dependence on operating mode Red LED Yellow Green
LED LED
TEACH-IN evaluation limit
Object detected off flashes flashes
Series
No object detected flashes off flashes
-D1
Object uncertain (TEACH-IN invalid) on off flashes
Normal mode (evaluation range) off on on
Fault flashes previous off
state
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on: 0 8/17/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 169
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
170 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -F64
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Model number Connection type Detection range Page
Series
-F43
UBE500-F64-SE0 cable 500 mm 172
UBE500-F64-SE0-V3 M8 connector, 3-pin 500 mm
UBE500-F64-SE2 cable 500 mm
Series
-F54
UBE500-F64-SE2-V3 M8 connector, 3-pin 500 mm
UBE1500-F64-SE0 cable 1500 mm
UBE1500-F64-SE0-V3 M8 connector, 3-pin 1500 mm
Series
-F64
UBE1500-F64-SE2 cable 1500 mm
UBE1500-F64-SE2-V3 M8 connector, 3-pin 1500 mm
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 171
Through-beam ultrasonic barrier UBE...-F64-...
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UBE1500-F64-SE0-V3
UBE1500-F64-SE2-V3
UBE500-F64-SE0-V3
UBE500-F64-SE2-V3
UBE1500-F64-SE0
UBE1500-F64-SE2
Model number
UBE500-F64-SE0
UBE500-F64-SE2
Series
-F42
! ! ! !
-F64
2 m, PVC cable ! ! ! !
emitter: 2 x 0.34 mm²
receiver: 3 x 0.34 mm²
Material
Series
Housing PA 6.6 ! ! ! ! ! ! ! !
LUC
Fu nc tio n
Double sheet
monitoring
A through-beam ultrasonic barrier always co nsists of a single e mit ter a nd a single rece iver. T he function o f a through-beam ultrason ic barrier is b ase d
in the interrup tion of the sou nd transmission to the rece iver by the ob ject to be dete cte d.
Th e emitter sends a n ultra son ic signal tha t is evalu ated b y the receiver. If the signal is interrupte d or mute d by th e object to be d etected, t he receiver
switch es.
No e lectrical connections are required betwe en the e mitter a nd rece iver.
Th e function of th roug h-be am u ltrasonic barriers is n ot de penden t on the posit ion of their installation. We reco mmend , how ever, to install the emitter
Power supplies
Control units/
below in th e case of vert ical inst allations to p revent t he accumulation of dust particles.
Ins talla tio n tol eranc es
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Th e in sta llation tolerances of the ce ntra l axes of the emitter and receiver m ay not exceed th e va lue s spe cified in the illust ration.
Detection o f thin fo ils
Fo r the detection of th in foils (< 0.1 m m), install the th roug h-be am ultra son ic barrier at an angle of > 10° from pe rpen dicular to the foil.
Cau tio n
Accessories
Moun t or replace emitter and receiver o nly in pairs. Bo th device s a re o ptim ally matche d to each o ther by the ma nufacturer.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
172 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UBE...-F64-...
-12GM
Series
25 25
17 17
LED LED (receiver only)
-18GK/-18GM
Series
32
40
32
40
Series
-30GM
ø 3.5
VariKont
Series
ø 3.5
12
12
Series
-FP
18
18
ø 24 ø 24
Series
-F12
UBE...-F64-SE.-V3 (connector version) UBE...-F 64-SE. (cable version)
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
1 BN
-F43
(BN)
+UB +UB
U 4 (BK) U BK
3 (BU) BU
-UB -UB
Series
Receiver: version E2, pnp Receiver: version E2, pnp
-F54
1 (BN) BN
+UB +UB
U 4 (BK) U BK
3 (BU) BU
-UB -UB
Series
-F64
Emitter: Emitter:
1 (BN) BN
+UB +UB
U U
3 (BU) BU
-UB -UB
Series
-D1
Core colours in accordance with EN 60947-5-2.
Diagrams
Series
LUC
Characteristic response curves Characteristic response curves Mounting/Adjustment Thin foil detection
Angle [degrees] Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30 90 80 70 60 50 40 30
≥10˚
Double sheet
monitoring
20 20
α
A
10 10
0.0 0 0 -0
0.1 0.25
Power supplies
-10 -10
Control units/
0.3 0.75
0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 1 1.25 1.5 1.75
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
α α
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 173
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
174 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series -D1
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Model number Detection range Page
UC500-D1-3K-V7 500 mm 176
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 175
Ultrasonic sensor UC500-D1-3K-V7
-12GM
Series
20 V AC ... 252 V AC
Series
• 3 relay outputs
• Parameter assignment via DIP-switches
• Temperature compensation
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UC500-D1-3K-V7
Model number
Series
Range hysteresis 20 mm !
Temperature influence <4 % !
Sensing range 60 ... 550 mm !
Unusable area 0 ... 60 mm !
Standard target plate 100 mm x 100 mm !
Series
< 110 mA at UB = 10 V DC
< 25 mA at UB = 220 V AC
Ambient temperature -20 ... 60 °C (253 ... 333 K) !
Storage temperature -40 ... 85 °C (233 ... 358 K) !
Protection degree IP65 !
Series
!
LUC
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
176 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UC500-D1-3K-V7
-12GM
Series
ø 75
ø 65
-18GK/-18GM
Series
68
Series
-30GM
39
28
Accessories
M30x1,5
VariKont
Series
ø 64,5
146
158
Series
-FP
50
65
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Standard symbol/Connection:
Series
-F43
1
U UB
2
UB
3
Series
-F54
4
A1
5
A2
A3 6
Series
-F64
Series
Diagrams -D1
Series
LUC
Angle [degrees]
LED S4 = OFF S4 = ON
Double sheet
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
monitoring
1
Control units/
0.0 -0
0.1
ON
1
-10
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
0.2
switch output
2
0.3 -20
adjustment
3
0.4
0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9
Distance [m]
overspill warning run-dry warning
4
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 177
UC500-D1-3K-V7
-12GM
Series
Safety notes:
The supply circuit is separated from the relay circuit by basic insulation.
-18GK/-18GM
Series
The cover may only be opened by specially trained personnel. Degree of contamination 2 is permis-
sible when the cover is open. Ensure that the sealing ring of the cover is in good condition.
Safety class II is only guaranteed when using the accessorial cable box and the associated mounting
screw with plastic head. When operating this device with operating voltage exceeding 42 V, you must
Series
-30GM
replace the metal mounting screw by the supplied plastic head mountig screw to avoid electric treat-
ment. The cable box may only be separated from the unit when the power is off.
CAUTION:
VariKont
Series
The UC500-D1-K3-V7 ultrasonic sensor is not suitable for use in environments subject to explosion hazards.
Conformity: EN 60947-5-2
Series
Degree of contamination: 4
Overvoltage category: III
TEACH-IN of switching points:
Series
-F12
One switching point can be taught for each of the 3 switch outputs. Set DIP switch 5 to ON to put the sensor in TEACH-IN
mode. The sensor indicates TEACH-IN mode with two lit red LEDs. The green-yellow LEDs are off.
Next, position a suitable target object at the desired switching point in front of the sensor and switch the DIP switch associated
with the relevant switch output (switches 1-3). The sensor will now be flashing yellow or green in addition to the lit red LEDs.
Flashing green indicates that the target object was detected; flashing yellow signals that it was not detected. The measured
Series
-F42
switching point will be transferred to RAM when the associated DIP switch is switched back while the LED is flashing green.
Only the red LEDs should now be lit. This signals the user that the DIP switches 1-3 have been restored to their original posi-
tions. The other switching points are set in the same manner. The TEACH-IN procedure is completed by setting DIP switch 5
back to the OFF position. The measured switching points will then be transferred to the nonvolatile EEPROM.
Series
Under normal circumstances, switching point A1 should be less than A2, and A2 less than A3. If this is not observed, the sensor
-F43
will automatically exchange the switching points after the TEACH-IN procedure is complete so that A1 < A2 < A3. This ensures
that the LEDs respond correctly and that the shortest switching point is assigned to relay 1, the middle distance to relay 2 and
the longest distance to relay 3.
If DIP switch 4 is switched during TEACH-IN, the default value for the switching point will be set rather than a target object. The
Series
-F54
default values for the switching points are 60 mm for A1, 220 mm for A2 and 270 mm for A3.
LED 2, green/yellow flashes green off lit green off lit green
Double sheet
monitoring
LED 3, green/yellow off flashes yellow lit yellow off lit yellow
The relays switch to the "safe state" (all relays open, regardless of close/open function) during TEACH-IN.
Control units/
The relays switch to the "safe state" (all relays open, regardless of close/open function) in the event of a failure
Setting the display modes:
Two display modes can be selected with DIP switch 4:
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
178 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
UC500-D1-3K-V7
-12GM
Series
Display mode 1: DIP switch 4 ON, underfill warning:
-18GK/-18GM
Object distance x x < A1 A1 < x < A2 A2 < x < A3 x > A3
Series
LED 1, red (full) flashes off off off
LED 2, green/yellow (normal) off lit green off off
LED 3, green/yellow (low) off off flashes yellow off
Series
-30GM
LED 4, red (empty) off off off flashes
In this mode LED 1 (red) serves as the overfilling indicator, LED 2 (green) indicates the normal state, LED 3 (yellow) serves as
the preliminary warning that the container is nearly empty and LED 4 (red) signalises the "container empty" state.
VariKont
Series
Display mode 2: DIP switch 4 OFF, overfill warning
Series
-FP
LED 2, green/yellow (high) off flashes yellow off off
LED 3, green/yellow (normal) off off lit green off
LED 4, red (empty) off off off flashes
Series
-F12
In this mode LED 1 (red) serves as the overfilling indicator, LED 2 (yellow) serves as the preliminary warning that the container
is nearly full, LED 3 (green) indicates the normal state, and LED 4 (red) signalises the "container empty" state.
The relays switch to the "safe state" (all relays open, regardless of close/open function) in the event of a failure.
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 179
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
180 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series LUC
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Model number Detection range Page
LUC4T-G5P-IU-V15 4000 mm 182
LUC4T-G5S-IU-V15
Series
-F43
LUC4T-N5P-IU-V15
LUC4T-N5S-IU-V15
Series
Type code/ordering information
-F54
L U C 4 T – – I U – V15
Series
-F64
Connection type (electrical)
V15 V15-connector (M12 x 1) 5-pin
Electrical output
Series
IU 4 mA ... 20 mA und 0 V ... 10 V
-D1
Material of process connection
Pr ocess connection
Measuring range
Power supplies
Control units/
4 0,3 m ... 4 m
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 181
Ultrasonic level sensor LUC4T-G5.-IU-V15
-12GM
Series
• Function monitoring
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
LUC4T-G 5P-IU-V15
LUC4T-G 5S-IU-V15
LUC4T-N5P-IU-V15
LUC4T-N5S-IU-V15
Model number
Series
-F42
Standards EN 60947-5-2 ! ! ! !
LED green power on ! ! ! !
LED red 2 Hz flashing: error ! ! ! !
Operating voltage 20 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS ! ! ! !
Power consumption ≤ 1200 mW ! ! ! !
Series
-F54
! !
Material
Housing PBT, stainless steel 1.4571 ! !
PBT, polypropylene ! !
Transducer PTFE (diaphragm surface) ! ! ! !
Mass 220 g ! ! ! !
Series
-D1
Dimensions
Series
LUC
V15 connector
Double sheet
monitoring
76
Power supplies
50
Control units/
G1½A
or
1½" NPT
ø 44
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Calibration and
configuration connector
LED LED
Accessories
M12x1
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
182 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Electrical connection Diagrams LUC4T-G5.-IU-V15
-12GM
Series
Standard symbol/Connection:
Characteristic response curves
1 (BN)
-18GK/-18GM
+ UB Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30
4 (BK) 4...20 mA 20
Series
U 2 (WH) 0...10 V
3 (BU)
- UB
5 (GY) 10
n.c.
Series
-30GM
0.0 0
0.5
1.0 -10
1.5
VariKont
Series
2.0 -20
2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 5.0 5.5
Distance [m]
Series
-FP
Additional information
Series
-F12
Product description:
The LUC4T-... ultrasonic sensor is especially designed to measure the fill level of liquids. With its Teflon-coated surface, the
sensor is outstandingly suited for use with corrosive liquids. The masking of fixed objects permits the sensor to be deployed
in locations in which struts or other internal structures extend into the measuring field.
Series
-F42
Sensors of the LUC4T-... series feature a 4 mA ... 20 mA current and 0 V ... 10 V voltage output as standard. The outputs
have fail-safe behaviour in the event of a fault.
Function
The ultrasonic converter sends out an acoustic pulse. This pulse is reflected by the contents of the container and registered
Series
-F43
by the converter after traveling the measurement distance.
A microprocessor evaluates the echo signals and determines the fill level.
Sources of interference such as weld seams, fixed installations, etc. are suppressed reliably via the masking of fixed objects.
Temperature-related changes of the velocity of sound are compensated.
Series
-F54
Measuring system:
A measuring system consists of a LUC4T-...-IU-V15 ultrasonic level sensor and a DA5... . display unit or power supply. The
LUC4T-...-IU-V15 ultrasonic level sensor can also be connected directly to a PLC.
Series
Compensation:
-F64
Compensation (not installed) Compensation (installed) Plug posit ion
1. Empty TEACH-IN 1. Empty TEACH-IN T
simulation of 0 % level approach 0 % level in container (wait 15 s)
Series
-D1
(wait 15 s)
Accept empty value Accept empty value A1
Empty value accepted (red LED flashing) Empty value accepted (red LED flashing) A1
Empty TEACH-IN complete Empty TEACH-IN complete T
Series
LUC
Full value accepted (red LED flashing) Full value accepted (red LED flashing) A2
Full TEACH-IN complete Full TEACH-IN complete T
TEACH-IN complete TEACH-IN complete T
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 183
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
184 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Series UDC / UDB
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
Model number Description Page
-F42
UDC-18GM-400-3E3 Optimised for double sheet detection 186
with integrated evaluation unit
UDC-18GMA-400-3E3 Optimised for double sheet detection 190
Series
-F43
with integrated evaluation unit
Angled sensor head version
UDB-18GM35-3E2 Optimised for double sheet detection 194
UDBL-18GM35-3E2 Optimised for label detection 196
Series
-F54
UDBK-18GM35-3E2 Optimised for jointing/splice detection 198
Applications:
Series
-F64
The ultrasonic double-sheet monitor is deployed in all situa- - Deployment in letter-opening machines to verify the com-
tions in which the automatic distinction between single and plete emptying of the opened envelopes.
double sheets is required in order to protect machines or
avoid waste production. - Deployment in document counters, in which the ultrasonic
Series
double-sheet monitor ensures that bank deposit slips, for
-D1
For example: example, are properly counted.
- Deployment in printing machines, in which the ultrasonic - Deployment in packaging machines for the detection of
double-sheet monitor prevents damage to the complex splices in aluminium packaging foil and proper regulation
Series
LUC
mechanics by the inadvertent feed of two sheets or en- of the machine speed.
sures that the second sheet does not remain in the ma-
chine. - Detection of air, single and double sheet in paper process-
Double sheet
ing machinery.
monitoring
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 185
Ultrasonic double sheet monitor UDC-18GM-400-3E3
-12GM
Series
• Ultrasonic system for reliable detection of no, one, or two overlapping sheet
materials, preferably papers
• No TEACH-IN required
-18GK/-18GM
Series
U
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UDC-18G M-400-3E3
Model number
Series
-F42
Voltage drop ≤2 V !
Switch-on delay approx. 25 ms !
Switch-off delay approx. 25 ms !
Pulse extension min. 120 ms parameterisable !
Input type Function input !
Series
-F64
b
Control units/
+UB
(PK)
Function input β = 35˚
a = 5 ... 15 mm
(WH)
Output single sheet b ≥ 10 mm s < +/- 1 mm
d = 40 ... 45 mm
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
(BK)
s
(BU)
-UB
β
d
a
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
186 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UDC-18GM-400-3E3
-12GM
Series
Evaluation unit with
receiver unit
-18GK/-18GM
Series
wires 70 mm with LEDs 4
wire end ferrules 24
l=2m
M18x1
Series
-30GM
45
72
74
VariKont
Series
l = 0.5 m
Emitter unit
24
Series
ø 15
-FP
M18x1
70 500 22
Series
-F12
Additional information
Series
-F42
Description of sensor functions
The ultrasonic double sheet monitor is used for double sheet detection in all situations in whic h the automatic distinction between double
and single sheets is required in order to protec t machines or avoid waste produc tion. The double-s heet monitor is based on the ultrasonic
Series
-F43
through-beam princ iple. The following can be detected:
- No sheet, i.e. air,
- Individual sheet
- Double sheet
Series
A microprocessor system ev aluates the signals. T he appropriate switc h outputs are s et as a result of the evaluation. Changes in ambient
-F54
conditions such as temperature and humidity are compensated for automatically. The interfac e electronics is integrated into a c ompact
M18 metal hous ing together with a s ensor head.
Switching on
Series
-F64
The s ensor is equipped with 6 c onnec tions . The functionality of the connections is desc ribed in the following table. T he func tion input
(PK) is used to assign parameters to the sens or. (See Output pulse ex tens ion, Alignment aid and Program selection). During normal
operation, the func tion input m us t alw ays be securely connected with +UB or -U B, to avoid poss ible interference or improper functionality.
Series
-D1
BN +UB
WH Switch output for single sheets Pulse width corresponds to the event
BK Switch output for double sheets Pulse width corresponds to the event
GY Switch output for air Pulse width corresponds to the event
Series
LUC
Normal mode
The sens or is working in normal mode if the function input (PK) is applied to -U B or +UB when the power sourc e (Power-On) is supplied,
as s hown in the output pulse extension table (s ee below).
Displays:
Power supplies
Control units/
Switch outputs:
The switch outputs are only active in normal operation!
White: WH Single sheet output
Blac k: BK Double sheet output
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 187
UDC-18GM-400-3E3
-12GM
Series
Please note:
This can result in a c ondition in which more than one switch output is switched through!
Display Mode
VariKont
The selected param eter ass ignment of the s ensor can be displayed by switc hing the function input (PK) to voltage-free during normal
Series
operation. The green LED displays the program number (the number of flashing pulses (1 ... 4) = the program number).
The outputs are inactiv e during this time.
If the function input (PK) is switc hed to voltage-free when power is supplied (Power-On), the s ensor will also w ork in dis play mode.
If the unit is switc hed to v oltage-free w hile the function input (PK) is in operation due to an error (broken cable, coming loose because
Series
-FP
Parameter assignment
The sensor is equipped with 4 programs for different ranges of application. T his makes it possible to work with a w ide range of material.
Series
The us er can selec t the program best suited for a s pecific application.
-F12
The default setting, Progr am 1, is design ed so that no change in the setting is required for mo st app lications.
Programs
Program number Notes: Range of materials
Series
-F42
When the func tion input (PK) is applied to -UB (for > 500 ms), the mode changes. When the "Program selec tion“ mode is activ e,
switc hing on function input (PK) on to +U B (for > 500 ms) s elects the next program lev el.
Disconnecting the power supply causes the system to exit the current mode with the selected program change.
Series
The switc h outputs are not active w hile parameters are being assigned to the sensor!
-D1
prolongation
... and function input
(PK) unconnected
(PK) unconnected
-UB
-UB
Alignment aid Program select
Power supplies
Control units/
+UB +UB
no function toggle cyclically
next program
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
188 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
UDC-18GM-400-3E3
-12GM
Series
Modes
Alignment aid
-18GK/-18GM
Series
During installation, the DSM can provide an adjustment aid for optimal alignment of the emitter to the receiver.
If the s ensor detects an area of air (y ellow LED is lit) the DSM w ill begin to display the intensity of the measured amplitude signal:
- If the signal is weak, the yellow LED will flash at a slow rate
- As the int ensity of the signal increases, the rate at which the LED flashes becomes faster
- At optimal alignment (maximum signal intensity), the yellow LED is continuously lit.
Series
-30GM
The single sheet function (green LED) and double sheet function (red LED) continues to be active. This makes it possible to check for
correc t func tionality of the double sheet c ontrol.
Program selection
In the program selec tion mode, the current program is display ed by the green LED (number of flashing pulses = program number).
VariKont
Series
Applying the adjus tment input (PK) to +UB (for > 500 ms) caus es the nex t program to be selec ted in cyclic s equenc e (program 1
follows through to program 4).
Notes:
Series
A complete dev ice consists of an ultrasonic emitter and an ev aluation unit with an ultrasonic emitter. The sens or heads are optimally
-FP
adjusted to each other when they leav e the factory. Therefore, they must not be used separately or ex changed with other dev ic es of
the same type. The plug c onnector on the emitter/receiver c onnection c able is only intended to be used for easier mounting, not to
replace units.
Very light papers (for example handkerchiefs) or perforated papers are not always s uitable for double sheet detec tion because of their
Series
-F12
physical charac teris tics.
If two or more double sheet controls are used in the immediate vic inity of eac h other, there may be mutual interference between them,
which can res ult in improper functionality of the devices. Mutual interference can be prev ented by introduc ing suitable c ountermeas u-
res when planning s ystems .
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 189
Ultrasonic double sheet monitor UDC-18GMA-400-3E3
-12GM
Series
• Ultrasonic system for reliable detection of no, one, or two overlapping sheet
materials, preferably papers
• No TEACH-IN required
-18GK/-18GM
Series
U
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UDC-18G MA-400-3E3
Model number
Series
-F42
≤2 V
-F54
Voltage drop !
Switch-on delay approx. 25 ms !
Switch-off delay approx. 25 ms !
Pulse extension min. 120 ms parameterisable !
Input type Function input !
0-level: -UB ... -UB + 1V
Series
-F64
Mass 150 g !
Double sheet
monitoring
β = 35˚
Control units/
+UB
(PK) b
Function input
a = 5 ... 15 mm b β
(WH)
Output single sheet b ≥ 10 mm
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
(BK)
Output double sheet
U
(GY)
Output air
(BU)
-UB
a
a
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
190 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UDC-18GMA-400-3E3
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
wires 70 mm with Evaluation unit with
wire end ferrules receiver unit
LEDs
l=2m
Series
-30GM
M6
11
86
20
30
54
Emitter unit
ø6.3
VariKont
Series
M18x1
10
Series
-FP
36 10 45 18
87
Series
-F12
Additional information
Series
-F42
Description of sensor functions
The ultrasonic double sheet monitor is used for double sheet detection in all situations in whic h the automatic distinction between double
and single sheets is required in order to protec t machines or avoid waste produc tion. The double-s heet monitor is based on the ultrasonic
Series
-F43
through-beam princ iple. The following can be detected:
- No sheet, i.e. air,
- Individual sheet
- Double sheet
Series
A microprocessor system ev aluates the signals. T he appropriate switc h outputs are s et as a result of the evaluation. Changes in ambient
-F54
conditions such as temperature and humidity are compensated for automatically. The interfac e electronics is integrated into a c ompact
M18 metal housing together w ith a s ensor head. To ensure a reliable operation of the double sheet monitor, the detec tion threshold is
adapted dynamically to the detected paper thicknes s.
Series
-F64
Switching on
The s ensor is equipped with 6 c onnec tions . The functionality of the connections is desc ribed in the following table. T he func tion input
(PK) is used to assign parameters to the sens or. (See Output pulse ex tens ion, Alignment aid and Program selection). During normal
operation, the func tion input m us t alw ays be securely connected with +UB or -U B, to avoid poss ible interference or improper functionality.
Series
-D1
Colour Switching on Comments
BN +UB
WH Switch output for single sheets Pulse width corresponds to the event
BK Switch output for double sheets Pulse width corresponds to the event
Series
LUC
GY Switch output for air Pulse width corresponds to the event
PK -UB/+UB Function input for parameter assign-
ment/pulse prolongation
Double sheet
BU -UB
monitoring
Normal mode
The sens or is working in normal mode if the function input (PK) is applied to -U B or +UB when the power sourc e (Power-On) is supplied,
as s hown in the output pulse extension table (s ee below).
Power supplies
Control units/
Displays:
LED yellow : Detection of air
LED green: Detection of single sheets
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 191
UDC-18GMA-400-3E3
-12GM
Series
Please note:
This can result in a c ondition in which more than one switch output is switched through!
Display Mode
VariKont
The selected param eter ass ignment of the s ensor can be displayed by switc hing the function input (PK) to voltage-free during normal
Series
operation. The green and the red LED display alternately the program number and the operation mode.
LED green: Number of blinking pulses = program number
LED red: single flas hing = continous operation mode
double flashing = pulsed operation mode
Series
If the function input (PK) is switc hed to voltage-free when power is supplied (Power-On), the s ensor will also w ork in dis play mode.
If the unit is switc hed to v oltage-free w hile the function input (PK) is in operation due to an error (broken cable, coming loose because
of vibration), display mode acts as a fault display .
Series
-F12
Parameter assignment
The sensor is equipped with 4 programs for different ranges of application. T his makes it possible to work with a w ide range of material.
The us er can selec t the program best suited for a s pecific application.
The default setting, Progr am 1, is design ed so that no change in the setting is required for mo st app lications.
Series
-F42
Programs
Program number Notes: Range of materials
1 Default setting, standard paper 20 - 1200 g/m 2
Series
-F43
Operation modes
The double sheet monitor offers the poss ibility to select between c ontinous operation mode and pulsed operation mode. Due to the
pulsed operation mode is pre-selected as the standard mode, most applications need no modification.
Series
It is possible to s witch to additional parameter as signment modes from the dis play mode:
Alignment mode -->
Program selec tion mode -->
Operation mode s election mode -->
Series
-D1
Disconnecting the power supply causes the system to exit the current mode with the selected program change.
The switc h outputs are not active w hile parameters are being assigned to the sensor!
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
192 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
UDC-18GMA-400-3E3
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
... and function input (PK)
Series
at +UB or -UB
Power ON Normal mode -UB +UB
selection
... and function input pulse prolongation
(PK) disconnected
function input
Series
-30GM
Display mode Display mode
(PK) disconnected
VariKont
Series
Alignment aid Program selection Mode selection
(yellow LED) (green LED) (red LED)
Series
-FP
(cyclically)
Modes
Alignment aid
Series
-F12
During installation, the DSM can provide an adjustment aid for optimal alignment of the emitter to the receiver.
If the sensor detec ts an area of air (yellow LED is lit) after 3 s ec onds, the DSM will begin to display the intensity of the measured
amplitude s ignal:
- If the signal is weak, the yellow LED will flash at a slow rate
Series
-F42
- As the int ensity of the signal increases, the rate at which the LED flashes becomes faster
- At optimal alignment (maximum signal intensity), the yellow LED is continuously lit.
The single sheet function (green LED) and double sheet function (red LED) continues to be active. This makes it possible to check for
correc t func tionality of the double sheet c ontrol.
Series
Program selection
-F43
In the program selec tion mode, the current program is display ed by the green LED (number of flashing pulses = program number).
Applying the adjus tment input (PK) to +UB (for > 500 ms) caus es the nex t program to be selec ted in cyclic s equenc e (program 1
follows through to program 4).
Operation mode s election
Series
-F54
In the operation mode selection mode, the current program is displayed by the red LED.
single flashing: c ontinous operation mode
double flashing: pulsed operation mode
Applying the adjus tment input (PK) to +UB (for > 500 m s) causes an alteration of the operation mode.
Series
-F64
Notes:
A complete dev ice consists of an ultrasonic emitter and an ev aluation unit with an ultrasonic emitter. The sens or heads are optimally
adjusted to each other when they leav e the factory. Therefore, they must not be used separately or ex changed with other dev ic es of
Series
the same type. The plug c onnector on the emitter/receiver c onnection c able is only intended to be used for easier mounting, not to
-D1
replace units.
Very light papers (for example handkerchiefs) or perforated papers are not always s uitable for double sheet detec tion because of their
physical charac teris tics.
If two or more double sheet controls are used in the immediate vic inity of eac h other, there may be mutual interference between them,
Series
LUC
which can res ult in improper functionality of the devices. Mutual interference can be prev ented by introduc ing suitable c ountermeas u-
res when planning s ystems .
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 193
Ultrasonic double sheet monitor UDB-18GM35-3E2
-12GM
Series
• Ultrasonic system for detection of single sheet, no sheet and double sheet.
Also detection of pasted double sheets.
• Weights of paper from 30 g up to cartons weighing over 1200 g can be
-18GK/-18GM
detected.
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UDB-18G M35-3E2
Model number
Series
-F42
Mass 370 g !
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
S1 4
Double Single Relative position
sheet sheet 20 ... 45˚
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
10
3
-UB
U
mm
Paper position:
80
the emitter
20
TEACH-IN key
2
+UB
d=
S2 -10
0.2
Accessories
4
-20
No sheet
0.4
-UB 0.6 0.8 1.0
Distance [m]
Emitter
α
(black cable)
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
194 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UDB-18GM35-3E2
-12GM
Series
Connector Receiver 36 37
-18GK/-18GM
M12 x 1.5
Series
6.8
30
30
S1
M12 x 1
86
98
38
38
M12 x 1
Series
-30GM
S3 6.8 S2
VariKont
Series
18.5 64 18.5
Connector Emitter
4 Ultrasonic-Transducer (Emitter)
2.5 m
24
Series
-FP
M18 x 1
35
Series
-F12
Additional information
Series
-F42
De scrip tio n o f th e sen sor fu nction s
In additio n to the printin g industry, the ultrasonic double-she et mon ito r is deployed in all situations in w hich the a utomatic distin ction betw een single and
dou ble she ets is req uired in order to p rotect ma ch ine s or avoid waste production. T he double-sheet mon itor is ba sed on the ultra so nic through-beam prin-
cip le. The follow in g can be d etected:
- No sh ee t
Series
-F43
- In di vidu al sh ee t
- Do ubl e she et or pa ste d do ub le sh eet
A microp rocessor system evaluates the signals. T he appropria te switch outputs are set as a result of the evaluation. C hang es in am bient conditions su ch
as tempe ratu re and hu midity are autom atically comp ensated. T he evaluation electronics a re installed in a cuboid plastic housing separate from the sensor
hea ds.
Series
-F54
Mea surin g system
A complete system con sists of an u ltrasonic emitter, an ultraso nic receiver and an evaluation u nit. The se units have been optimally tu ned to one ano ther
at th e factory a nd may no t be used sep arate ly.
Al ign me nt
Series
When adjustin g the em itt er an d receiver, take care to alig n them as p recise ly as possible .
-F64
Distance of the sensor heads: d = 20 mm ... 80 mm
Angu lar tolerance: α < + /- 2 °
Maximum offset: s < + /- 2 mm
T o ensure t heir correct function, the sensor heads must be aligned at an a ngle of 20° ... 45° from ve rtical on to the pape r surfa ce . The pa per is guided over
Series
the emitter at a distance o f 5 m m ... 15 mm. The emitter is in sta lled below in ord er to prevent dust dep osits. In sta ll th e sensor head s using the included
-D1
plastic nu ts. T he sound con e must be completely co vered by the pa per. T his means that th e se nso r head s m ust b e installed abo ve t h e sh eet of pap er and
at least 10 mm aw ay fro m the side ed ge of th e paper.
Max imu m fee d sp eed of the s heet (app rox imate val ue) Series
LUC
v m ax [m /s] = overlap pin g of sheets [m m] / 5 m s (overlapping > 20 m m)
T EACH -IN
1. After the o pe ratin g volta ge h as be en a ppl ie d, a sing le sh ee t can be fed i n as the firs t she et. It wil l au to matica ll y b e pro gra mmed a s a refere nce va lu e by the syste m.
Double sheet
monitoring
2. If a sin gl e she et of pa per i s loc ated b etwe en th e ul tra son ic em itte r and rece ive r w he n the o pe ratin g vol ta ge is turne d o n, it wil l au to mati call y be p rog ramme d as a refere nce valu e by
th e system.
IN signa l. In ord er to do this, a sin gle sh eet of p aper must be b etwee n the e mitt er an d re ceiver for a t le ast 10 s.
Ca ution !
T he p ape r sh eets may n ot to uch th e sens or he ads d urin g o pera tio n. De pen di ng o n p hy sical co nd itio n s, re flec tio ns o n th e ed ge o f a sing le sh eet
m ay resu lt in d o ub le-s heet o utpu t. Th is is n ot an error, and can b e ma sked ou t i n the hig he r-leve l con tro l sys tem .
Sensor system s for ult rasonic doub le-sheet m onitoring can also be de livere d with a cust omised time response for op tima l adaptat ion to specific ap plica-
tions.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 195
Ultrasonic label control UDBL-18GM35-3E2
-12GM
Series
detected.
Series
ambient conditions.
• Signal output via short-circuit proof PNP switch outputs.
• Very high processing speeds are possible.
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UDBL -18GM35-3E2
Model number
Series
-F42
Switch-off delay ≤ 1 ms !
Input type 1 pulse input for TEACH-IN !
Pulse length ≥ 100 ms !
Impedance ≥ 10 kOhm !
Voltage 12 ... 30 V !
Series
Standards EN 60947-5-2 !
-F64
Standard symbol/Connection:
Double sheet control
Characteristic response curves Mounting/Adjustment
1 Receiver
+UB Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30 (yellow cable)
Double sheet
monitoring
2 20
S1 4
Double Base Relative position
sheet material 10 20 ... 45˚
3
-UB
U
mm
Paper position:
80
2 the emitter
+UB
20
d=
Power supplies
Control units/
S2 4 -10
0.2
Label
-UB
-20
0.4
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Angular alignment
α < +/- 2˚
Accessories
Sensor offset
s < +/- 2 mm
s
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
196 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UDBL-18GM35-3E2
-12GM
Series
Connector Receiver 36 37
-18GK/-18GM
M12 x 1.5
Series
6.8
30
30
S1
M12 x 1
86
98
38
38
M12 x 1
Series
-30GM
S3 6.8 S2
VariKont
Series
18.5 64 18.5
Connector Emitter
4 Ultrasonic-Transducer (Emitter)
2.5 m
24
Series
-FP
M18 x 1
35
Series
-F12
Additional information
Series
-F42
De scrip tio n o f th e sen sor fu nction s
Ultrasonic doub le-sheet monitorin g to dete ct labels is used in all situations in which an a utomat ic d istinctio n m ust be mad e be tween labels an d carrier
mat erial as w ell a s double she ets in order to p rotect machines or avoid w ast e production. T he double-she et mo nit or is ba sed on the ultrasonic thro ugh-
bea m principle. T he follo wing can be detected:
- Base m ateria l
Series
- La bel
-F43
- Do ubl e she et
A microprocessor system evaluates t he signals. T he appropria te sw itch outpu ts are set as a result of the evaluation. T he e va lua tion electronics are installed
in a cuboid p lastic housing separate from th e sensor h eads.
Series
-F54
A complete system con sists of an u ltrasonic emitter, an ultraso nic receiver and an evaluation u nit. The se units have been optimally tu ned to one ano ther
at th e factory a nd may no t be used sep arate ly.
Al ign me nt
When adjustin g the em itt er an d receiver, take care to alig n them as p recise ly as possible .
Series
Distance of the sensor heads: d = 20 mm ... 80 mm
-F64
Angu lar tolerance: α < + /- 2 °
Maximum offset: s < + /- 2 mm
T o ensure t heir correct function, the sensor heads must be aligned at an a ngle of 20° ... 45° from ve rtical on to the pape r surfa ce . The pa per is guided over
the emitter at a distance o f 5 m m ... 15 mm. The emitter is in sta lled below in ord er to prevent dust dep osits. In sta ll th e sensor head s using the included
plastic nu ts. T he sound con e must be completely co vered by the pa per. T his means that th e se nso r head s m ust b e installed abo ve t h e sh eet of pap er and
Series
-D1
at least 10 mm aw ay fro m the side ed ge of th e paper.
Max imu m fee d sp eed of the s heet (app rox imate val ue)
De pends on the label and gap w idth as well as the ma terials in question.
Approxim ate value 10 m/s while maintaining th e req uired m inimum sizes.
Series
LUC
c ≥ 35mm
g ≥ 2mm
LB ≥ 15mm
Label
Label
LB
c
LL ≥ 15mm
Double sheet
monitoring
LL g
T EACH -IN
Power supplies
Control units/
Before start ing a valid TEAC H-IN a wa rm up p eriod of ap prox. 5 min must be m ain tain ed. After the warm up pe riod and a short-tim e reset of the op erat ing
voltage a valid value is automat ically ta ught in, provid ed that a carrie r ma terial and labe l is betw een em itt er an d receiver.
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Ca ution !
Accessories
T he p ape r sh eets may n ot to uch th e sens or he ads d urin g o pera tio n. De pen di ng o n p hy sical co nd itio n s, re flec tio ns o n th e ed ge o f a sing le sh eet
m ay resu lt in d o ub le-s heet o utpu t. Th is is n ot an error, and can b e ma sked ou t i n the hig he r-leve l con tro l sys tem .
Sensor system s for ult rasonic doub le-sheet m onitoring can also be de livere d with a cust omised time response for op tima l adaptat ion to specific ap plica-
tions.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 197
Ultrasonic splice control UDBK-18GM35-3E2
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UDBK-18G M35-3E2
Model number
Series
-F42
Standards EN 60947-5-2 !
Ambient temperature 0 ... 60 °C (273 ... 333 K) !
Storage temperature -40 ... 70 °C (233 ... 343 K) !
Protection degree IP65 !
Connection emitter: V1-Wconnector with 2.5 m cable !
receiver: 2.5 m fixed cable (not disconnectable)
Series
-D1
Standard symbol/Connection:
Double-sheet-control
Characteristic response curves Mounting/Adjustment
1 Receiver
+UB Angle [degrees]
90 80 70 60 50 40 30 (yellow cable)
2
Double sheet
20
monitoring
S1 4
Double sheets Single Relative position
or splices sheet 10 20 ... 45˚
3
-UB
U
mm
Paper position:
80
the emitter
20
TEACH-IN key
2
+UB
d=
S2 -10
Power supplies
Control units/
0.2
4
-20
No sheet
0.4
-UB 0.6 0.8 1.0
Distance [m]
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Emitter
α
(black cable)
Angular alignment
α < +/- 2˚
α
Accessories
Sensor offset
s < +/- 2 mm
s
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
198 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UDBK-18GM35-3E2
-12GM
Series
Connector Receiver 36 37
-18GK/-18GM
M12 x 1.5
Series
6.8
30
30
S1
M12 x 1
86
98
38
38
M12 x 1
Series
-30GM
S3 6.8 S2
VariKont
Series
18.5 64 18.5
Connector Emitter
4 Ultrasonic-Transducer (Emitter)
2.5 m
24
Series
-FP
M18 x 1
35
Series
-F12
Additional information
Series
-F42
De scrip tio n o f th e sen sor fu nction s
Ultrasonic double-sh eet m onitoring to det ect splice po int s is used in all situa tion s in which an autom atic distinction m ust be m ade b etwee n splice points
and doub le sh eets in order to prot ect machines or avoid w aste production. Doub le-sheet monitoring for splice p oin t dete ction is b ase d on the ultrasonic
through-beam principle. Th e follo wing can be detected:
- No sh ee t
Series
-F43
- In di vidu al sh ee t
- Spl ice p oin t o r d ou ble shee t
A microp rocessor system evaluates the signals. T he appropria te switch outputs are set as a result of the evaluation. C hang es in am bient conditions su ch
as tempe ratu re and hu midity are autom atically comp ensated. T he evaluation electronics a re installed in a cuboid plastic housing separate from the sensor
hea ds.
Series
-F54
Mea surin g system
A complete system con sists of an u ltrasonic emitter, an ultraso nic receiver and an evaluation u nit. The se units have been optimally tu ned to one ano ther
at th e factory a nd may no t be used sep arate ly.
Al ign me nt
Series
When adjustin g the em itt er an d receiver, take care to alig n them as p recise ly as possible .
-F64
Distance of the sensor heads: d = 20 mm ... 80 mm
Angu lar tolerance: α < + /- 2 °
Maximum offset: s < + /- 2 mm
T o ensure t heir correct function, the sensor heads must be aligned at an a ngle of 20° ... 45° from ve rtical on to the pape r surfa ce . The pa per is guided over
Series
the emitter at a distance o f 5 m m ... 15 mm. The emitter is in sta lled below in ord er to prevent dust dep osits. In sta ll th e sensor head s using the included
-D1
plastic nu ts. T he sound con e must be completely co vered by the pa per. T his means that th e se nso r head s m ust b e installed abo ve t h e sh eet of pap er and
at least 10 mm aw ay fro m the side ed ge of th e paper.
T EACH -IN
1. After the o pe ratin g volta ge h as be en a ppl ie d, a sing le sh ee t can be fed i n as the firs t she et. It wil l au to matica ll y b e pro gra mmed a s a refere nce va lu e by the syste m.
Double sheet
monitoring
2. If a sin gl e she et of pa per i s loc ated b etwe en th e ul tra son ic em itte r and rece ive r w he n the o pe ratin g vol ta ge is turne d o n, it wil l au to mati call y be p rog ramme d as a refere nce valu e by
th e system.
Ca ution !
T he p ape r sh eets may n ot to uch th e sens or he ads d urin g o pera tio n. De pen di ng o n p hy sical co nd itio n s, re flec tio ns o n th e ed ge o f a sing le sh eet
m ay resu lt in d o ub le-s heet o utpu t. Th is is n ot an error, and can b e ma sked ou t i n the hig he r-leve l con tro l sys tem .
Sensor system s for ult rasonic doub le-sheet m onitoring can also be de livere d with a cust omised time response for op tima l adaptat ion to specific ap plica-
tions.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 199
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
200 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Control units/Power supplies
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Model number Description Page
UH3-KHD2-4E5 Control/evaluation unit with 4 switching outputs 202
UH3-KHD2-4I Control/evaluation unit with 4 analogue current outputs (4 mA ... 20 mA) 204
Series
-F54
UH3-T1-KT Control/evaluation unit with relay output for high power loads 206
DA5-IU-C Process indication device 208
DA5-IU-2K-C Process indication device 210
DA5-IU-2K-V
Series
-F64
WE77-RE2 Isolated switch amplifier with power supply und 2 relay outputs 212
KFA6-STR-1.24.500 Power supply 214
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edi ti on 0 8/18/20 05
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 201
Evaluation unit UH3-KHD2-4E5
-12GM
Series
• Synchronous operation
• Temperature compensation
• Reference measurement for highest accuracy
VariKont
Series
• 4 switch outputs
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UH3 -KHD2-4E5
Model number
NO/NC/REF (2 items)
switch point (1 item)
LED yellow channel number A1 ... A4 / object in operating range (4 items) !
Operating voltage 20 ... 30 V DC , ripple 10 %SS !
No-load supply current ≤ 50 mA (without sensors) !
Series
Mass 230 g !
-D1
The UH3-KHD2-4E5 is an evaluation device for ultrasonic sensors with external interface electronics. Up to four sensors of
Series
LUC
The evaluation unit issues the transmission pulses (cycle) for each sensor channel, then records the echo signal and forms the
sensing range according to the echo time. A switch output is associated with each channel.
Double sheet
monitoring
If the detected distance is less than the set switching point, the output of the associated channel is actuated according to the
selected open/close action. This is indicated by the yellow LED assigned to the channel.
Sensors with a variety of detection ranges can be deployed on the four evaluation channels. One of the channels can be pro-
grammed as a reference measurement for a temperature compensation.
Power supplies
Note:
Control units/
The maximum cable-length between evaluation unit and sensor must not exceed 20 m!
Date of edition: 09/13/2005
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
202 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UH3-KHD2-4E5
-12GM
Series
40 Extendable 110
latches
-18GK/-18GM
Series
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
A1 A2 A3 A4
92.5
90
UB UB UB UB
Series
-30GM
500 2000 4000 6000
Multi n.o. n.c.
REF
Sync
dist. OK
3 sec = Prog.
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
-UB
Echo
U
Series
Emitter pulse
-F43
+UB
Channel 1 Channel 2
24 V DC
Series
-F54
+UB -UB + - + -
+UB
-UB
Series
AN
-F64
AN GND T E T E
Temperature sensor
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
Series
A1 A2 A3 A4
-D1
UB UB UB UB
500 2000 4000 6000
Multi n.o. n.c.
REF
Series
LUC
Sync
dist. OK
3 sec = Prog.
Switch outputs: 13 14 15 16 17 18
Double sheet
19 20 21 22 23 24
monitoring
Channel 1
Reference potential -UB
A1 A2 T E T E
Channel 2
Power supplies
A3 A4 + - + -
Control units/
Channel 1
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 203
Evaluation unit UH3-KHD2-4I
-12GM
Series
• Synchronous operation
• Temperature compensation
• Reference measurement for highest accuracy
VariKont
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UH3 -KHD2-4I
Model number
rising/falling ramp
Repeat accuracy multiplex operation: ± 1 mm !
synchronous operation: ± 3 mm
Input type for 4 sensors for each of 4 connections +UB/-UB/clock (T)/echo (E) short-circuit proof with reverse-polarity protection !
attachable sensors:UB500/2000/4000/6000-...-H3 or -H1/-H2
Ambient temperature -20 ... 70 °C (253 ... 343 K) !
Series
-F64
The UH3-KHD2-4I is an evaluation device for ultrasonic sensors with external interface electronics. Up to four sensors of type
Series
The evaluation unit issues the transmission pulses (cycle) for each sensor channel, then records the echo signal and forms a
current value proportional to the echo time (4 mA ... 20 mA). An analogue output is associated with each channel.
Double sheet
An evaluation window and a rising or falling current ramp can be selected in the detection section for each output. If the distance
monitoring
determined is within the programmed measuring window, the output of the associated channel will deliver a value between 4
mA and 20 mA. The yellow LED associated with the channel will be lit.
Sensors with a variety of detection ranges can be deployed on the four evaluation channels. One of the channels can be pro-
grammed as a reference measurement for a temperature compensation.
Power supplies
Control units/
Note:
The maximum cable-length between evaluation unit and sensor must not exceed 20 m!
Date of edition: 09/13/2005
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
204 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UH3-KHD2-4I
-12GM
Series
40 Extendable 110
latches
-18GK/-18GM
Series
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
A1 A2 A3 A4
92.5
90
UB UB UB UB
Series
-30GM
500 2000 4000 6000
Multi
REF
Sync
nah fern
OK
3 sec = Prog.
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 23 24
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
-UB
Echo
Series
Emitter pulse
-F43
+UB
Channel 1 Channel 2
24 V DC
Series
-F54
+UB -UB + - + -
+UB
-UB
Series
AN
-F64
AN GND T E T E
Temperature sensor
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12
Series
A1 A2 A3 A4
-D1
UB UB UB UB
500 2000 4000 6000
Multi
REF
Series
LUC
Sync
nah fern OK
3 sec = Prog.
Analogue outputs: 13 14 15 16 17 18
Double sheet
19 20 21 22 23 24
monitoring
(4 mA ... 20 mA /
Channel 1
20 mA ... 4 mA)
Reference potential -UB
(4 mA ... 20 mA / A1 A2 T E T E
Channel 2
20 mA ... 4 mA)
Power supplies
Control units/
A3 A4 + - + -
(4 mA ... 20 mA /
Channel 1
20 mA ... 4 mA)
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
(4 mA ... 20 mA /
Channel 2 Channel 3 Channel 4
20 mA ... 4 mA)
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 205
Evaluation unit UH3-T1-KT
-12GM
Series
• Normally open/closed
• Switch point can be selected in steps in the sensing range
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
UH3 -T 1-KT
Model number
Storage temperature
Connection plug socket 11-pin, attached using 2 x M3 screws or snapped-on to 35 mm standard rail according to EN 50022 !
Base is included with delivery
Housing modular housing !
Mass 110 g !
Series
-F64
The UH3-T1-KT is a back-end unit for ultrasonic sensors with external evaluation logic. It features direct-detection and through-
Series
beam operating modes. All sensors of the types H3, H1 and H2 can be connected to the unit.
-D1
When an object is detected, a relay trips a change-over contact. The action and release delays can be adjusted independently
of one another. In direct-detection mode the unit generates a clock signal for the sensors and determines the object distance
on the basis of the echo time. A switching point can be set in steps in the detection range.
Series
LUC
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
206 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions UH3-T1-KT
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
35 27 72
38
Series
-30GM
78
65
VariKont
Series
35
(99)
Connector socket
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
-F43
20 ... 30 VDC 4 2 +Power 20 ... 30 VDC
Series
-F54
GND 3 1
}
Sensor 1
Sensor 2
Sensor 3
Input 1 (echo) 7 11
Series
-F64
10 - Power GND
Input 2 (echo) 8
Series
-D1
Input 3 (echo) 9
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 207
Digital display unit DA5-IU-C
-12GM
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
DA5-IU-C
Model number
Pre-selection none !
Data storage 106 storage cycles or 10 years, EEPROM !
Series
Resolution 14 Bit !
Scale factor via linear characteristic curve !
Reset maximum value, manually !
Key interlock - !
Operating voltage 10 ... 30 V DC !
Series
Impedance 1 MOhm !
Voltage max. 30 DC !
Analogue voltage input 0 ... 10 V / 2 ... 10 V DC !
Analogue current input 0 ... 20 mA / 4 ... 20 mA !
Ambient temperature -10 ... 50 °C (263 ... 323 K) !
Series
-F64
!
-D1
Mass approx. 50 g !
Series
The DA5-IU-C permits a simple visual inspection by operating and maintenance personnel. It converts the analogue sensor output signal into
LUC
a readable form for this purpose. Depending on the task or setting, 4 ... 20 mA or 0 ... 100 % values can be displayed.
Scope of deliver y:
Double sheet
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
208 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions DA5-IU-C
-12GM
Series
max. 19.3
48
-18GK/-18GM
Series
22 x 45
24
Series
-30GM
4
59 6.5
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Terminal
Series
-F43
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 No.
1 10 ... 30 V DC
2 0 V (GND)
3 0 V LATCH
4 LATCH
Series
5 Current input
-F54
6 0 V input signal
7 Voltage input
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 209
Process control and indication equipment DA5-IU-2K-.
-12GM
Series
• Programmable characteristics
• Resetting the outputs, automatic, manual or with external signal
• Connection via plug-in screw terminals
• Auxiliary power output for sensors (Only DA5-IU-2K-V)
Series
-30GM
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
DA5-IU-2 K-C
DA5-IU-2 K-V
Model number
Pre-selection 2-fold ! !
Data storage 106 storage cycles or 10 years, EEPROM ! !
Series
-F42
90 ... 260 V AC !
Power consumption 2W !
7 VA !
Sensor supply 24 V DC , 100 mA !
Relay 2 x 250 V AC/ 300 V DC, 3 A, changeover contact ! !
Series
-F64
Mass 220 g ! !
LUC
The DA5-IU-2K-... permits a simple visual inspection by operating and maintenance personnel. It converts the analogue sensor output signal
into a readable form for this purpose. Depending on the task or setting, 4 mA ... 20 mA or 0 % ... 100 % values can be displayed.
Double sheet
monitoring
Scope of deliver y:
• Process control unit DA5-IU-2K-...
• Screw terminals
1 RM 5.08 8-pole terminal for power supply and outputs
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
210 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions DA5-IU-2K-.
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
max. 19
Series
96 15.5
44.9x91.9
Series
-30GM
48
VariKont
Series
Control panel cutout 4
67.1 6.5
Series
45+0.6
-FP
92+0.8
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
-F43
10 ... 30 V DC 0 V DC (...-C)
Connector S1/... Connector S2/...
S2/7 S2/8
OUT 1
Ammeter input S1/1 S2/3
Series
S2/2 Relay 2
-F54
Reference earth S1/2
S2/1
Voltmeter input S1/3 OUT 2
S2/6
Indicator S2/5 Relay 1
Key lock-out "Key" S1/6
Series
S2/4
-F64
Reference earth for reset S1/7
Reset S1/8
Series
-D1
4 5 10 S1/11 S1/9
0 V DC
+24 V DC,
100 mA
not assigned
on S1
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 211
Isolated switch amplifier WE77-RE2
-12GM
Series
• Modular housing
• For PNP-sensors the terminals 5 and 6, for NPN-sensors the terminals 6 and
7 are to short out
• Mode of operation: input closed - energising the relay/input open - relay de-
VariKont
Series
energised
Series
-FP
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
WE77 -RE2
Model number
Voltage 24 V DC ± 20 % !
Current 160 mA at 60 °C , short-circuit proof !
Contact loading AC: 250 V / 4 A / 500 VA / cos φ ≥ 0.7 !
DC: 220 V / 0.1 A; 60 V / 0.6 A; 24 V / 4 A
Energised/De-energised delay approx. 20 ms / approx. 10 ms !
Series
-F43
Switching frequency ≤ 10 Hz !
Ambient temperature -25 ... 60 °C (248 ... 333 K) !
Storage temperature -25 ... 85 °C (248 ... 358 K) !
Construction type modular housing !
Protection degree IP20 !
Series
-F64
When using proximity switches (sensors) in pnp-technique (switched high), the connections 5 and 6 have to be bridged
LUC
When using proximity switches (sensors) in npn-technique (switched low), the connections 6 and 7 have to be bridged.
Double sheet
monitoring
Mode of operation
Input Output
Power supplies
energised
Control units/
de-energised
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
212 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions WE77-RE2
-12GM
Series
25
4.8
-18GK/-18GM
Series
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
30
70
Series
-30GM
30
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
VariKont
25 10
Series
60 110
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Series
I II
-F43
pnp npn
5 6 7 2 4 1+ 3-
Series
-F54
–
Series
~
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
11 12 10 14 15 13 16 17 ~ 18
Double sheet
monitoring
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 213
Power supply KFA6-STR-1.24.500
-12GM
Series
• 24 V DC output voltage
Series
Suitable connector cables, mounting aids and more, you can find in chapter "Accessories"
Technical Data
Series
-F12
KFA6-STR-1.24.50 0
Model number
Series
-F42
SIL/IEC 61508 no !
Fault message output no !
Explosion protection No Ex-protection !
Connection terminals 14, 15 !
Rated voltage 90 ... 253 V AC , 48 ... 63 Hz !
Series
Number of channels 1 !
Connection Power Rail or terminals 7+, 8- !
Current 500 mA at 60 °C , permanent short-circuit protection (electronically) !
Voltage 24 V ± 0,5 V !
Power supply/Output safe isolation acc. to DINVDE 0106, rated insulation voltage 253 Veff !
Series
-F54
Function
Series
-D1
The output voltage of the power supply is regulated and remains stable regardless of the size of the power supply and the load
current.
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
214 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Dimensions KFA6-STR-1.24.500
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Electrical connection
Power supply
Series
-F43
14 15
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
green
Series
-D1
+ -
7+ 8-
Series
LUC
Output Power Rail
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Date of edition: 08/18/2005
Accessories
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 215
Notes
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
216 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Type Description Page
Kabeldosen Ready-to-use and customisable 218
Series
-F43
MH 04-3505 Mounting aid for series -FP sensors 223
MH 04-2681F Mounting aid for series VariKont (+U1+ und +U9*) sensors 223
OMH 04 Mounting bracket for series -18GM sensors 224
Series
-F54
MHW 11 Mounting bracket for series -FP und -F42 sensors 224
MH-UDB01 Rotatable mounting bracket for ultrasonic double sheet monitors 224
BF12, BF18, BF30 Mounting flanges for series -12GM, -18GM and -30GM sensors 225
Series
-F64
M105 Mounting flanges for series -30GM sensors 226
BF18-F/BF30-F Mounting flanges for series -18GM and -30GM sensors 226
PA02 Mounting flanges for series -FP sensors 227
Series
-D1
BF 5-30 Universal mount for ø5 mm ... ø30 mm sensors 228
UVW90-K18 Redirection mirror for series -18GM and -30GM sensors 229
UVW90-K30
UVW90-M30 Focussing redirection mirror for ser ies -30GM sensors 229
Series
LUC
LUC4-Z30-N2V
FP100 Remote potentiometer for through beam barrier UBE4000-30GM-SA2-V1 230
USB-0,8M-PVC ABG SUBD9 Interface adapter USB/RS 232 231
UC-F43-R2 RS 232 interface for series -F43 sensors 231
Power supplies
Control units/
UB-PROG2/UB-PROG3 Programming units for all UB...-sensors with -V15 connector, where the TEACH- 233
input is at connector-pin 2 (UB-PROG2) or at connector-pin 5 (UB-PROG3).
Accessories
ULTRA 2001 Service program for easy programming of ultrasonic sensors with RS 232 interfaces 234
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 217
Accessories - cables, plugs, mating connectors
-12GM
Series
Wire cross-
Design
Nu mber of
Series
cable gland
V1S-G Connector, straight 4-pin max. 2.5 -
Fig. 6 Fig. 7 2)
Power supplies
Control units/
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
218 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories - cables, plugs, mating connectors
-12GM
Series
Technical data for connector with integrated cable
-18GK/-18GM
Connector and sockets
Series
Number of pins 2-, 3-, 4- or 5-pin
Series
-30GM
Self-locking via O-ring in cap nut
VariKont
Series
Material of contacts CuSn/Au
Series
Material of sealing ring NBR
-FP
protection class in accordance with DIN 40050 IP68 in screwed state
Series
-F12
Max. operational current 4A
Series
-F42
Test voltage 1500 Veff. AC, 50 Hz
Cable
Series
-F43
Cable structure finely stranded, flexible
Series
-F54
Colour of sheath grey
Series
-F64
moving: -5 °C bis +70 °C
Temperature range for PUR conductors 1)
non-moving: -30 °C bis +105 °C
Minimum permissible bending radius > 10 x conductor diameter, appropriate for conveyor chains
Series
∅4.6 mm for M8 and ∅4.8 mm for M12,
-D1
Sheath diameter
but ∅5.2 mm in 5-pin variant
2-pin: BN, BU
3-pin: BN, BU, BK
Core colours in acc. with VDE 293
4-pin: BN, BU, BK, WH
5-pin: BN, BU, BK, WH, GY (GN/YE bei PE)
Double sheet
monitoring
1)
Please note reduced mechanical values for PUR cables at temperatures over +80 °C.
Power supplies
Control units/
1 7.8.05
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 219
Accessories - cables, plugs, mating connectors
-12GM
Series
3 Blue BU
5
4 Black BK 3 3
5 Grey GR
VAZ-FK-CL1
VAZ-2FK-B1
VAZ-T1-FK-V1 Top view of plug side
VariKont
Series
VAZ-G6F-V1
VAZ-G6F-W2M
VAZ-T1-FK-PG9
VAZ-T1-FK-PG13.5
Colour assignment ready-to-use
Mating connectors V17, V7 and : Plug connector -V17 Plug connector -V7
(circular connector M12x1) (circular connector PG 13,5)
Series
-FP
1 4
-F12
6 7 2 3
5 Grey GR
6 Pink PK
7 Blue BU Top view of plug side
8 None
Series
(screening)
-F42
4 (BK)
-F54
4 2
(BK) (WH)
3 1
(BU) (BN) 3 1
(BU) (BN)
Series
-F64
Ø Design
Cable- No. of Design Design
Length 2 angled
sheath wires (mm ) straight angled
with 2 LEDs
Series
2m 3 0,25 V3-WM-E2-2M-PUR
-D1
10 m 3 0,25 V3-WM-E2-10M-PUR
Series
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
220 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories - cables, plugs, mating connectors
-12GM
Series
Cable connectors in M12 design for DC sensors
Suitable for DC sensors
-18GK/-18GM
with 2, 3 or 4 wires
Series
1(BN) 1(BN) 3
4
2
4 2 4 2 5
(BK) (WH) 8
Series
-30GM
(BK) (WH)
5
3(BU) (GR) 1
3(BU) 6 7
Design
Cable- No. of Ø Design Design
Length angled
VariKont
sheath wires (mm2) straight angled
Series
with 2 LEDs
Series
-FP
10 m 4 0,34 V1-G-10M-PVC V1-W-10M-PVC
V1-W-A2-5M-PUR
Series
PUR, grey 5m 4 0,34 V1-G-5M-PUR V1-W-5M-PUR V1-A0-5M-PUR
-F12
V1-W-E2/E3-5M-PUR
Series
-F42
V1-W-E2-5M-PUR
PUR, grey 5m 3 0,34
V1-W-E-5M-PUR
10 m 3 0,34 V1-W-E2-10M-PUR
Series
-F43
2m 5 0,34 V15-G-2M-PVC V15-W-2M-PVC
Series
-F54
2m 5 0,25 V15-W-2M-PUR
PUR, grey
5m 5 0,25 V15-W-5M-PUR
2m 7 0,25 V17-G-2M-PUR
Series
-F64
PUR, grey
5m 7 0,25 V17-G-5M-PUR
screened
10 m 7 0,25 V17-G-10M-PUR
Series
-D1
Suitable for DC sensors with 2, 3 or 4 wires
technique, cross-braided halogen free
lead or with PE Series
LUC
1(BN) 1(BN)
4 2 4 2
(BK) (WH) (BK) (WH)
Double sheet
monitoring
5
3(BU) (GN/YE)
3(BU)
Design
Cable- No. of Ø Design Design
Length angled
sheath wires (mm2) straight angled
with 2 LEDs
Power supplies
Control units/
PUR, cross- 2m 4+1 0,34 V15-G-2M-PUR S/PE V15-W-2M-PUR S/PE V15-W-A2-2M-PUR S/PE
Accessories
braided with
Da te o f issu e
PE, orange 5m 4+1 0,34 V15-G-5M-PUR S/PE V15-W-5M-PUR S/PE V15-W-A2-5M-PUR S/PE
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 221
-12GM
Series
)
Series
5(WH) 1(BK)
4(BN) 2(BU)
Series
-30GM
3 (GN)
Design Design
Cable sheath Length Number of wires Ø (mm2)
straight angled
VariKont
Series
V1 - W - E2 - 2M - PVC
- PUR
- PUR H/S, halogen free cross-braided
- PUR S/PE cross-braided, with PE
Series
-F42
Cable length 22 m
-5 m
- additional length on demand
Series
-F43
Design -W angled
-F64
-G straight
-WM angled with cap nut
-WR angled with twist connect
Series
- V3 M8 x 1, 3-pin, DC
- V3S M8 x 1, 3-pin, DC, connector
- V31 M8 x 1, 4-pin, DC
- V31S M8 x 1, 4-pin, DC, connector
1 7.8.05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
222 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories - mounting aids
-12GM
Series
MH 04-3505 Horizontal axis
1)
-18GK/-18GM
2
x. 5
pro
Series
ap
ø7
65
Series
-30GM
65
VariKont
Vertical axis
Series
Series
-FP
The type 04-3505 mounting accessory simplifies the adjustment of ultrasonic sen-
sors of the -FP and -F42 series.
Mounting accessory for the simple ad- It permits the completely installed and wired sensor to be swiveled by up to ±30° in
justment of -FP and -F42 series sensors 2 orthogonal axes.
Series
The sensor is locked in the desired position by tightening the mounting screws.
-F12
MH 04-2681F
Series
-F42
30
60
Series
-F43
90
Series
-F54
40
5.2
Series
-F64
30
For ultrasound sensors (VariKont® , +U9+ series) compliant with DIN 43694, EN
Series
-D1
Mounting accessory for the simple ad- 50025 oder EN 50037.
justment of VariKont ® series sensors The simple mounting is performed with traditional C-profile rails 1) as in
EN 50024 (15 x 30 x 1.5). For existing systems, the mounting accessories will also
fit on C-rails 1 that comply with the obsolete DIN 43662 standard (15 x 30 x 2). Gen-
Series
erous scope for adjustment in the x and y directions and 360° rotation simplify and
LUC
speed up installation and adjustment work. The adjustment of the sensor in the se-
lected position is performed using the switch mounting screws (included). Provision
has also been made for two-point mounting as an alternative to the C-rail. The re-
Double sheet
quired holes can be accessed through the central guide slot. M5 x 16 mm screws
monitoring
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 223
Accessories - mounting aids
-12GM
Series
15
35
Series
-30GM
9.5 30
62
VariKont
Series
ø12.2
ø18 mm sensors
Material
Angle: sheet steel, 60 19
Series
-FP
galvanised
Locking disc: sheet steel, For installation on ø12 mm round rod or sheet material (thickness 1.5 mm ...
galvanised 3 mm). Suitable for -18GM series sensors.
Locking profile: aluminium, diecast
Series
-F12
MHW 11 125 14
65 ± 0.1 7.5 6.5
Series
-F42
ø5.5
24
65 ± 0.1
Series
80
-F43
14
12
6.5
15
Series
-F54
40 6
sensors 30
2
Series
-F64
MH-UDB01
Series
LUC
˚
40
40
˚
6.5
50
70
R25
Double sheet
monitoring
27.5
6.5
3
34
Power supplies
Control units/
68 18.2
tors.
Accessories
70
85
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
224 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories - mounting aids
-12GM
Series
CPZ18B03
18mm cylindrical
photoelectric sensor
-18GK/-18GM
(not included)
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
2X screw
10-32 UNF x 63.5
on 50.8 centers
Mounting flange with tumble
mechanism.
2X bracket
Series
For sensors with an M18 threaded
-FP
housing
Swivel nut
Rotation range: 360°
Swing range: 10°
Series
-F12
(Delivery of mounting flange does not
include sensor) 2X lock nut
18mm hexnut
(not included)
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
BF12
Series
BF18
-F54
E
BF30 F B
A
Series
-F64
C
Series
D
-D1
Series
LUC
BF12 24 36 19 12 30 16 M4 x 20
BF18 30 44 23 18 40 26 M5 x 25
BF30 40 56 34 30 40 24 M5 x 40
Power supplies
Material: PBT
1 8.08.20 05
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 225
Accessories - mounting aids
-12GM
Series
M105
-18GK/-18GM
Series
1-1/2" NPT
M30x1.5
ø58.5
ø44.7
ø23
Series
-30GM
57
end thread (UB/UC300. -500 and -2000.
• Secure mounting
• Easy installation
• Robust design
Series
-FP
• Chemical-resistant
Material: PTFE
(Delivery of mounting asseccories does
Series
-F12
BF18-F
BF18-F 29
Series
BF30-F
-F42
30
24
14
Series
-F43
Ø 18
12
Series
-F54
4.2
4
7.81
4.1
Series
-F64
14
BF30-F 41 35
Series
-D1
33 29
Universal mounting for all cylindrical
sensors with ø18/ø30 mm
• The flange is mounted using the
35
24
LUC
range is 8 mm at maximum.
• Suitable screws for installation of 13
Ø 30
the mounting flange: M4
Double sheet
monitoring
4.2
4
Power supplies
Control units/
4.1
7.8
14
1 8.08.20 05
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
226 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories - mounting aids
-12GM
Series
PA02
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Ø 19
Series
-FP
22
Series
-F12
• Secure mounting
98
• Easy installation
178
• Robust design
Series
-F42
(Delivery of mounting flange does not
include sensor) Material: PVC
Series
-F43
Nut M12K-VE
Nut M18K-VE
Nut M30K-VE
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Plastic nuts with centering ring for vibra-
tion decoupled installation of cylindrical
Series
18 mm and 30 mm.
Material: PA
Power supplies
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 227
Accessories - mounting aids
-12GM
Series
BF 5-30 25 29
360˚adjustment
-18GK/-18GM
Series
25
SW3
Series
-30GM
40-60 adjustable
Mounting head
11
Threaded pin, internal hexagon SW2
VariKont
Foot fixing
Series
16
Series
-FP
360˚ adjustment
Uiversal mounting for all cylindrical sen-
sors with ø5 mm ... ø30 mm
Series
-F12
• Secure mounting 16
11.5
• Easy installation
• Flexible 360° adjustment of meas-
11
uring head and base
Series
-F42
• Robust design
15
The BF 5-30 mounting flange is sup-
plied with two mounting heads (ø18 M4, internal hexagon
mm, ø30 mm) and 4 sleeves (ø5 mm, ø SW3
Series
-F43
8
ø1
d
Series
-D1
Adapter bush
Mounting head ø18
50
3
Power supplies
Control units/
30
1 8.08.20 05
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
228 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories - sound deflectors
-12GM
Series
UVW90-K18 26.6
UVW90-K30
-18GK/-18GM
UVW90-K18
22
Series
Ø15
45˚
Series
-30GM
41
Ø3.2
9
VariKont
Series
41
Series
Sound deflector for cylindrical -18GM
-FP
and -30GM series ultrasonic sensors.
• Clamp mounting UVW90-K30
34
• 90° sound deflection for difficult
Series
installation circumstances
-F12
Ø 24
• Universal installation position
Series
-F42
width. Falling particle of dust can not
64
Ø 5.5
The function is also guaranteed in dusty
environment.
15
Series
-F43
Material: PMMA
Series
-F54
UVW90-M30
Series
-F64
45˚
104
Series
-D1
53
10 17.5
40
Series
Thickness 2mm
LUC
• Focusing effect
• Detection range increase (through
focussing)
- approx. 40% with UB/UC500
1 8.08.20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 229
Accessories - external temperature probes, remote potentiometers
-12GM
Series
UC-30GM-TEMP 27
-18GK/-18GM
7.5
6
Series
10
Series
-30GM
ø3
500
LUC4-Z30-G2V
LUC4-Z30-N2V
Series
½" NPT
-F12
G½" or
Series
-F42
8 mm plug connection
UC...-30GM-... series ... and UC...-30GM-... series as an alternative to the supplied temperature plug.
-F54
• 8 mm plug connector The use of the LUC4-Z30-... permits the ambient temperature of the measuring
area to be monitored independently of the installation conditions of the sensor in or-
• Single-hole mounting in thread: der to minimise temperature influences as effectively as possible.
G½A (LUC4-Z30-G2V)
Series
½NPT (LUC4-Z30-N2V).
-F64
FP100
Series
-D1
82 55
Series
LUC
+ +
Double sheet
monitoring
82
80
- -
Remote potentiometer
Power supplies
Control units/
on the transmitter
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
230 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories - programming aids
-12GM
Series
USB-0,8M-PVC ABG-SUBD9
Modern notebooks and PCs are often not equipped wit astandard RS 232 serial
-18GK/-18GM
interface.
Series
Anyhow, to allow the use of the multiple functions of the service program
ULTRA 2001, the interface adapter USB-0,8M-PVC ABG-SUBD9 offers a sim-
ple solution.
Series
-30GM
The interface adapter USB-0,8M-PVC ABG-SUBD9 provides a RS 232 serial in-
terface at a free USB port.
It can be connected to the USB port either directly or via the 800 mm USB cord,
Interface adapter USB/RS_232
VariKont
which is included in scope of delivery.
Series
Our interface cables can be connected to the 9 pin SUB-D connector in the ac-
customed way.
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
UC-F43-R2
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
RS 232 Sensor
5.5
Series
-F54
A1 A2
69
PEPPERL+FUCHS
Made in Germany
RS 232 interface UC-F43-R2 6
Part No. 102860
Series
• For the sensors
-F64
Supply
UC300-F43-2KIR2-V17 and
5.5
UC2000-F43-2KIR2-V17. M12x1
Series
-D1
The unit can be switched from the V17 cable connection socket and the V17 plug
connection on the sensor for the TEACH-IN procedure.
The parameterised functions are retained when the programming unit is removed
and/or the power is switched off.
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
1 8.08.20 05
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 231
Accessories - programming aids
-12GM
Series
UC-30GM-R2 3m
-18GK/-18GM
Series
UC-30GM-PROG 1m
Series
-F64
side end of the extension cable is connected to the sensor's temperature plug
socket. The sensor can be programmed with the temperature plug at the other
Extension cable
end of the cable.
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
1 8.08.20 05
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
232 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Accessories - ULTRA 2001 service software
-12GM
Series
UB-PROG2
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Adhesive label
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Programming device
max. 5 cm
• For ultrasonic sensors series
UB300
Series
UB400 -12GM
-FP
UB500 -18GM40 -E4
Pa
2
G
r
tN
O
o.
PR
1
UB800 -18GM75 -E5
02
B-
86
U
-V15 teach in
0
UB1000 -30GM -I
40
UB2000 F42(S) -U
Series
UB4000 -F54 A1 A2
-F12
UB6000
Series
distances A1/A2 or the measuring
-F42
The unit can be switched from the V15 cable connection socket and the V15 plug
window. connection on the sensor for the TEACH-IN procedure.
• Simple selection of the output func- The switching distances/measuring window and output function can be taught in us-
tion: ing the A1 and A2 buttons.
Window mode, normally open/nor- The taught-in switching distances and functions are retained when the programming
Series
-F43
mally closed function. unit is removed and/or the power is switched off.
One switching distance, normally
open/normally closed function.
Monitoring of the detection range.
Series
-F54
UB-PROG3
Series
-F64
!40
Series
-D1
A1
teach in
Series
A2
LUC
Programming device
• For ultrasonic sensors series
Double sheet
-E01
monitoring
UB500 -E23
-18GM75 -V15
22
UB1000 -E6
-E7
... whose teach-in input is on pin 5.
Adhesive label
Power supplies
Control units/
Window mode, normally open/nor- connection on the sensor for the TEACH-IN procedure.
The switching distances/measuring window and output function can be taught in us-
Accessories
The taught-in switching distances and functions are retained when the programming
open/normally closed function. unit is removed and/or the power is switched off.
Monitoring of the detection range.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 233
-12GM
Series
if present. These commands can be used to output measured values, configure the
• WINDOWS™ user interface with up evaluation process, switching outputs and/or analogue output, set and query pa-
Series
to 5 independent windows. rameters and control the general unit functions. This provides the user with an aid
• For all ultrasonic sensors with in adapting the sensor optimally to its specific application and visualising parame-
RS 232 interfaces. ters or measured results.
• Convenient parameterisation of all
Series
-30GM
Show lt: Graphical display of the measured distance. The set switching distances
-F12
measurements.
are marked. Simulated LEDs display the switching states of the outputs.
Parameters: All parameters are editable here. Display and input fields permit com-
Software and manual as free down- mands or parameters to be changed at the click of the mouse without detailed
load: knowledge of the relevant commands or their syntax.
Series
-F42
Send command: Sensor parameters are set and queried here in the same manner
http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com as with a terminal program (alternative to the parameterisation window).
Port Monitor: Display of commands sent to the sensor and received by it.
Procedure: Distance: Display of the currently measured distance in mm.
- Select your product, which can be pa-
Series
-F43
rameterised by ULTRA 2001 at our The program and sensor parameters read out by the program can be saved to the
„Products“ page. hard drive or a diskette. Measurement series can be started, the measurement data
- Click on "1830288.zip" in the „Further queried periodically and output to a printer or saved to the hard drive/diskette.
documents“ section.
Series
drive.
System requirements
The Ultra 2001 application will run on any PC or laptop. Windows 95/98/ME/NT4/
2000 or XP, an EGA or VGA graphic boards and a free RS 232 interface are re-
quired.
Power supplies
Control units/
1 8.08.20 05
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
234 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
-12GM
Series
-18GK/-18GM
Series
Series
-30GM
VariKont
Series
Series
-FP
Series
-F12
Series
-F42
Series
-F43
Series
-F54
Series
-F64
Series
-D1
Series
LUC
Double sheet
monitoring
Power supplies
Control units/
1 8.08.20 05
Accessories
Da te o f issu e
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 235
Additional information
Standards
The proximity switches of Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH are devel- Standards for electromagnetic compatibility
oped and manufactured consistently according to applicable
standards. Moreover, draft standards are taken into account
during new development, redesign, and changes to existing EN 50081 Basic technical standard for
products radiation interference
Part 1, Residential areas
German standards Part 2, Industrial areas
Draft IEC 61934 Control circuit devices and Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH is DIN ISO 9001-certified.
switching elements DC inter-
face for proximity sensors and
Da te o f issu e 200 5-08 -17 - Senso rs 1 C atalo g
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
236 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Additional information
The CE logo is a declaration by the manufacturer that the so Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH is a member of ALPHA, an assocation
designated product conforms to the European standards and for the testing and certification of low-voltage devices, e. V.
directives that are applicable to the product. The following di- This association promotes individual responsibility on the part
rectives are applicable to Pepperl+Fuchs products: of manufacturers of such devices through unified testing
guidelines compliant with applicable standards, and thus sup-
89/336/EEC EMC directive (EN 60 947-5-2) ports high product quality. Through ALPHA's membership in
LOVAG (Low Voltage Agreement Group), government-recog-
73/23/EEC Low-voltage directive (cf.
nised product certifications issued by ALPHA under certain
VDE 0160, product standard
conditions are also recognised in other European countries.
EN 60947-5-2)
Directive 94/9/EC Equipment and protective sys- Resistance of our housing materials to
tems intended for use in poten- chemical substances
tially explosive atmospheres
The following tabular listing of the chemical resistances of our
Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH certifies the conformance of their prod- housing materials gives some indications for the application of
ucts with applicable directives in a manufacturer declaratioin. our sensors in aggressive environmental conditions (next
page).
Da te o f issu e 200 5-08 -17 - Senso rs 1 C atalo g
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 237
Chemical resistance
Chemically resistant to V2A ABS Epoxy PBT PC POM PP PPS PS PVC
Acetone + - - + - + + + - -
Formic acid 20 °C 40% + 10% - - 85% O 40% 50%
Ammonia + 25% O 10% - + + + + O
Petrol + 25% + + O + - + - +
Benzene + - + + - + - + - -
Brake fluid - O - - - + + - - -
Butane - + + - + + + + - +
Butanol - - - - - + + - - 40 °C
Calcium chloride - + - 10% + + + + + 60 °C
Chlorobenzene 20 °C - + - - + - - - -
Diesel oil - + + + O + 60 °C + - -
Acetic acid 20 °C 25% O + 10% 10% 70% + 50% 40 °C
Formaldehyde + 30% 50% 30% - + 40% 37% 40% +
Frigen 113 - - - - + - - + - +
Fruit juice + - + - + + + - - +
Glycerine + + + + O + + + + 60 °C
Heating oil - O + + O + 60 °C + - -
Hydraulic oil - - - - + + 60 °C - - +
Caustic potash - 50% O 3% - + 50% - 50% 60 °C
Potassium chloride + - - - + + + - + 60 °C
Potassium hydroxide + - - - - - + - - -
Linseed oil + + - - + + + - + +
Methanol + - + + - + + + - +
Methylene chloride + - - - - O O + - -
Lactic acid 20 °C 80% + - + + + - 80% O
Mineral oils + - + + - + + + - +
Motor oils + + - + - + + + O -
Sodium carbonate + + - - + + + - + -
Sodium chloride + + - - + + + - + +
Sodium hydroxide 20 °C + - - - - + - - -
Caustic soda 20 °C 50% - 3% - + + - 50% +
Nitric acid 66% - - - 10% - 25% - 10% +
Hydrochloric acid - O - 10% 20% - + - 10% O
Lubricating oil + - + - + O/+ + - - -
Carbon disulphide + - - - - + + - - O
Sulphuric acid - 50% - 28% 50% - 80% 50% 50% 70%
Sea water (cold) + - + + - + + + - +
Seifenlauge + - + - O + + - - +
Detergent + - - - - - + - - -
Turpentine + - + - O - + - - +
Carbon tetrachloride + - - - O - - - - O
Toluene + - + + - + - + - -
Trichlorethylene + - - + - - - O - -
Water + + 68 °C 68 °C + + + + + 60 °C
Tartaric acid 20 °C + + - + 10% + - + 60 °C
Xylene + - - + - + - + - -
Da te o f issu e 200 5-08 -17 - Senso rs 1 C atalo g
Zinc sulphate - + - - + - + - - -
Citric acid 20 °C + + - 10% + + - + -
Legend:
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
238 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Additional information
Protective enclosures
(DIN VDE 0470 Part 1, EN 60529)
IP 6 7
Notes:
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 239
Additional information
⇒ Timer function
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
240 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Additional information
Ultrasonic sensors operating simulta- This is the power consumption of the EN 40050 classifies the protection of
neously with overlapping detection ar- sensor itself under no-load conditions. electrical apparatus against touch,
eas may interfere with one another. penetration of objects or water through
For this reason, minimum distances Normally closed the housing, uncovering, and so on.
between the sensors must be main- The IP code consts of the letters "IP"
If the sensor does not detect an object,
tained. (International Protection) and two dig-
then the output is energised. When an
- If the sensors are transmitting in the its:
object is detected it is de-energised
same direction, the lateral safety dis-
(normally closed, n.c.). 1st digit:
tance corresponds to around half the
sensing range. Degree of protection against contact
Normally open and foreign objects
- In the case of opposed sensors, the
distance should amount to slightly If the sensor does not detect an object, 2nd digit:
more than the sum of the sensors' then the output is de-energised. When Degree of protection against entry of
sensing ranges. an object is detected it is energised water
(normally open, n.o.).
The use of synchronisable sensors is
⇒ Table "Protective enclosures"
recommended if these safety distanc- Objects
es cannot be maintained. Pulse extension
The specification of a sensing range is
Light emitting diodes normally based on a flat standard Time function by means of which the
measuring plate measuring 100 x 100 switching time can be extended, pro-
Pepperl+Fuchs ultrasonic sensors are mm which is positioned at right angles vided it is shorter than the value of the
equipped with LEDs to signal a variety to the sensor axis. The sensing ranges pulse extension.
of states. for sensors for very small distances
are sometimes based on smaller ⇒ Timer function
Please refer to the appropriate data
sheets for the significance of the indi- plates (see data sheets).
Solid materials, powders and liquids
Quality assurance
vidual LEDs.
can be detected. The standards DIN ISO 9000-9004
Linearity When working with poorly reflecting
materials (felt, cotton wool, foam rub- (EN 29000-29004) regulate the quality
⇒ Accuracy of measurement ber, coarse textiles), we recommend assurance (QA) of products and serv-
deploying ultrasonic sensors as reflex ices.
Measuring output sensors.
Hot materials (>100 °C) are poor re- Pepperl+Fuchs is certified in accord-
Absolute: The measuring output indicates ance with
flectors.
the distance of the object from the face of
the sensor in millimeters. The output is ei- ⇒ Section "Notes for installation DIN ISO 9001.
ther analogue (4 mA ... 20 mA, or 0 V ... 10 and operation"
V) or digital (parallel 8-bit or serial RS232). Range hysteresis
Relative: The measuring output gives the PBT
position of the object within the window This is the separation of the switch
area (A1/A2 or lower limit/upper limit). Polybutyleneterephthalate points between the condition when the
measuring plate approaches the sen-
Measuring range PC sor and the condition when it is moving
away from the sensor. The hysteresis
Evaluation range of measuring sen- Polycarbonate is given as a percentage of the operat-
sors. The starting value of the measur- ing distance (range).
ing range is determined by the "lower
PMMA
limit" the end value by the "far limit" of Range
Polymethylmethacrylate
the sensor.
Usable distance between the ultrason-
Probe
Mounting accessories ic transmitter and receiver (through-
⇒ Reflection sensor beam), sensor and reflector (interrupt-
The catalogue lists mounting brackets ed beam), or sensor and object (reflec-
and angles for use with sensors, which tion sensor).
can be adjusted relative to each other.
These items simplify adjustment and ⇒ Sensing range
alignment of the sensors.
Rated operating current
No load current
This value represents the maximum
This represents the self current re- operating current for continuous oper-
1 7.08.20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 241
Additional information
The rated operating voltage is given in The term generally refers to the re- ⇒ Repeat accuracy
terms of a maximum and minimum val- versal of the direction of waves at the
ue of the supply voltage. Satisfactory border between two media. Residual current
operation of the sensor is assured in A distinction is made between three
Current in the load circuit of the sensor
this range. types of reflection:
when in blocked state.
- Specular reflection: A reflection in
Rated operating voltage which virtually the entire incoming ra- Resolution
diation is reflected with the angle of
The rated operational voltage is given
incidence equaling the angle of re- The smallest change in the measure-
in terms of a maximum and minimum
flection, as in a mirror. ment variable that can be detected and
value of the supply voltage,
- Predominately specular reflection: A represented by a measuring sensor.
e.g. Ve = 10 V DC ... 30 V DC.
mirror reflection with a diffuse share,
Correct operation of the sensors is as- Response time
e.g. from roughened surfaces.
sured within this range.
- Diffuse reflection: A reflection in
which the incoming radiation is re- The shortest possible time between
Readiness delay two switching processes. The re-
flected evenly in all directions.
sponse time corresponds to half the
The readiness delay is the time that
The manner in which an ultrasonic switching frequency.
passes from switch-on of the operating
voltage to the point when a proximity beam is reflected depends on the ratio
of the wavelength to the roughness of Reverse polarity protection
switch is ready to operate.
the surface.
All Pepperl+Fuchs ultrasonic sensors
Reference axis are protected against incorrect con-
⇒ Section "Notes for installation
and operation" nection of the operating voltage.
Ideal line upon which the transmitter
and receiver (through-beam) or sensor Ripple
and object/reflector (reflection sensor
Reflective capability
or reflection barrier) are positioned. In The property of objects, depending on The alternating voltage which is super-
the case of single-head systems the surface nature and structure, to reflect imposed on the direct operating volt-
reference axis refers to the line of sym- ultrasonic waves to a greater or lesser age (peak to peak) is expressed as a
metry of the ultrasonic beam; in twin- extent, directionally or diffusely. The percentage of the arithmetic mean val-
head systems it is the central line be- non-reflected is absorbed or transmit- ues. Pepperl+Fuchs sensors conform
tween the ultrasonic beam axes of the ted. In the case of reflection sensors, to the standard EN 50008 in having a
transmitter and receiver. the attainable sensor range can be es- maximum ripple of 10%.
hour test at 23 ±5 °C and at the rated moved. The control element must
operating voltage. The difference be- switch reliably in the sensing range sd.
tween two operating distances must
not exceed 10% of the nominal operat-
Da te o f issu e
ing distance.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
242 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Additional information
Physical principle upon which the func- (previously: switch-off time) On fixed cylindrical sensors with
tion of a sensor is based. threaded housings, the recommended
Period of time required by the sensor tightening torque of 15 Nm should not
Setting from the point at which the object is re- be exceeded.
moved from the detection area, to the
The sensitivity of a number of ultrason- point at which switching occurs. Timer function
ic sensor types can be adjusted using (Switch-on delay is analogous to this)
a potentiometer to ensure that they are Parameterisable time function for the
optimally suited to their deployment. Switch-on delay switch output of a sensor.
changeover at the boundary of the re- separate, active devices, the ultrason- and A2.
gion. ic transmitter and the receiver.
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 243
Alphabetical Type Index
Croatia Germany
Peppe rl +Fuchs Gm bH w orl dwi de
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
246 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH worldwide
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 247
Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH worldwide
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
248 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH worldwide
Belize Colombia
Zentrale USA JR Controls Industrial & Automation Instrumentos & Controles
USA Head Office (FA Representation) (PA Representation)
Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. 100 Metros Norte de la Cruz Calle 39 No. 22 - 45
1600 Enterprise Parkway Roja Desamparados BOGOTA, D.C.
TWINSBURG OHIO, 44087 SAN JOSE (Costa Rica) Telephone +57 1 2088080
Telephone +1 330 4253555 Telephone +506 2597904 Telefax +57 1 2088060
Telefax +1 330 4254607 Telefax +506 2504558 [email protected]
[email protected]
Bermuda Sensortec
Address see (FA + PA Distributor)
USA Head Office Calle 95
Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. #9A-08
BOGOTA, D.C.
Bolivia Telephone +57 14007018
Hiller Electric SA Telefax +57 14006945
Av. El Trompillo 573
Casilla 370 Alfatecnica Export
SANTA CRUZ (FA + PA Distributor)
Telephone +591 3 3524484 Calle 95
Telefax +591 3 3526404 #9A-08
[email protected] BOGOTA, D.C.
Telephone +57 14007018
Brazil Telefax +57 14006945
Pepperl+Fuchs Ltda.
Rua Agostino Pelosini, 73/81 H & D Export
Anguilla Vila Olga (FA + PA Distributor)
Address see CEP 09720-220 SAO BERNARDO Calle 95
USA Head Office DO CAMPO #9A-08
Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. Telephone +55 11 4339 9935 BOGOTA, D.C.
Telefax +55 11 4338 7547 Telephone +57 14007018
Antigua [email protected] Telefax +57 14006945
Address see
USA Head Office British Virgin Islands Costa Rica
Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. Address see Elvatron S.A.
USA Head Office (PA Representation)
Argentina Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. 400 Metros Norte de la Agencia
Bruno Schillig S.A. del Banco de Costa Rica
Arenales (Dip. Ortiz) 4030 Canada La Uruca SAN JOSE
1602 Florida, BUENOS AIRES Address see Telephone +506 2961060
Telephone +54 11 47301100 USA Head Office Telefax +506 2190298
Telefax +54 11 47617244 Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. [email protected]
[email protected]
Cayman Islands Euro-Tec S.A.
Aruba Address see (PA Distributor)
Address see USA Head Office Apartado Postal 477-1250
USA Head Office Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. SAN JOSE
Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. Telephone +506 3847869
Chile Telefax +506 2961542
Bahamas Desimat Ingenieria Ltda. [email protected]
Address see (FA Representation)
USA Head Office Rut.: 78.131.420-K JR Controls Industrial & Automation
Pepperl+Fuchs Inc. Av. Puerto Vespucio 9670 (FA Representation)
Loteo Industrial Puerto Santiago 100 Metros Norte de la Cruz
Barbados PUDAHUEL-SANTIAGO Roja Desamparados
Address see Telephone +56 2 7470152 SAN JOSE
USA Head Office Telefax +56 2 7470153 Telephone +506 2597904
Pepperl+Fuchs Inc.
Da te o f issu e 0 8/17/05 – C atalo gue ? ?? 20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 249
Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH worldwide
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
250 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH worldwide
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 251
Pepperl+Fuchs GmbH worldwide
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 253
Notes
N otes
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
254 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com
Notes
Date of edi ti on 0 8/17/20 05
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com 255
Notes
Subject to reasonable modifications due to technical advances. Copyright Pepperl+Fuchs, Printed in Germany
256 Pepperl+Fuchs Group • Tel.: Germany +49 621 776-0 • USA +1 330 4253555 • Singapore +65 67799091 • Internet http://www.pepperl-fuchs.com